blob: b5037200507c9fd20be512724e063106b0e4a0fe [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100458 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200460 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200461 - noepoll
462 - nokqueue
463 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100468 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200469 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100470 - tune.maxaccept
471 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200472 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200473 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100474 - tune.rcvbuf.client
475 - tune.rcvbuf.server
476 - tune.sndbuf.client
477 - tune.sndbuf.server
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100478 - tune.zlib.memlevel
479 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481 * Debugging
482 - debug
483 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484
485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004863.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487------------------------------------
488
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200489ca-base <dir>
490 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200491 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
492 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494chroot <jail dir>
495 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
496 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
497 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
498 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
499 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
500 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200502crt-base <dir>
503 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
504 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
505 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
506
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507daemon
508 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
509 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
510 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
511
512gid <number>
513 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
514 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
515 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
516 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518group <group name>
519 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
520 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100521
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200522log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
524 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100525 configured with "log global".
526
527 <address> can be one of:
528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100529 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100530 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
531 port).
532
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100533 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
534 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
535 port).
536
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100537 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
538 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
539 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
540 writeable).
541
542 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543
544 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
545 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
546 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
547
548 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200549 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
550 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
551 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
552 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
553 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
554 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200556 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100558log-send-hostname [<string>]
559 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
560 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
561 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
562 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
563 the logs.
564
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000565log-tag <string>
566 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
567 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
568 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
569 running on the same host.
570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571nbproc <number>
572 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
573 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
574 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
575 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
576 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
577
578pidfile <pidfile>
579 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
580 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
581 starting the process. See also "daemon".
582
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200583stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
584 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
585 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
586 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
587 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
588 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
589 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
590 the number of processes used.
591
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200592stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
593 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
594 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
595 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
596 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200597
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200598 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
599 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
600 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200601
602stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
603 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
604 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100605 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200606
607stats maxconn <connections>
608 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
609 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611uid <number>
612 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
613 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
614 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
615 one. See also "gid" and "user".
616
617ulimit-n <number>
618 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
619 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
620 option.
621
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
623 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
624
625 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
626 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
627 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
628 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
629 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
630 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
631 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
632 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
633 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
634 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636user <user name>
637 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
638 See also "uid" and "group".
639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200640node <name>
641 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
642
643 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
644 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
645 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
646 traffic.
647
648description <text>
649 Add a text that describes the instance.
650
651 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
652 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
653 "<" and ">" characters.
654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657-----------------------
658
659maxconn <number>
660 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
661 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
662 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
663 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
664
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200665maxconnrate <number>
666 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
667 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
668 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
669 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
670 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
671 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
672 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
673 fairness.
674
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100675maxcomprate <number>
676 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
677 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
678 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
679 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
680 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
681 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
682 default value.
683
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100684maxpipes <number>
685 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
686 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
687 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
688 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
689 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
690 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
691
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200692maxsslconn <number>
693 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
694 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
695 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
696 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
697 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
698 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
699 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
700
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100701maxzlibmem <number>
702 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
703 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
704 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
705 The default value is 0.
706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707noepoll
708 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
709 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100710 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711
712nokqueue
713 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
714 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
715 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
716
717nopoll
718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100723nosplice
724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
731 "option splice-response".
732
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200733spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
734 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
735 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
736 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
737 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
738 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
739
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200740tune.bufsize <number>
741 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
742 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
743 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
744 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
745 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
746 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
747 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
748 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400749 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
750 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
751 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200752
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200753tune.chksize <number>
754 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
755 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
756 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
757 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
758 checks whenever possible.
759
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100760tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
761 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
762 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
763 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
764 this value. The default value is 1.
765
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200766tune.http.maxhdr <number>
767 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
768 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
769 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
770 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
771 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
772 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
773 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
774 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
775 limit too high.
776
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100777tune.maxaccept <number>
778 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
779 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
780 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100781 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100782 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
783 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100784 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100785 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
786
787tune.maxpollevents <number>
788 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
789 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
790 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
791 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
792 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
793
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200794tune.maxrewrite <number>
795 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
796 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
797 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
798 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
799 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
800 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
801 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
802 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
803 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
804 bufsize.
805
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200806tune.pipesize <number>
807 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
808 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
809 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
810 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
811 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
812 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
813
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100814tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
815tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
816 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
817 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
818 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
819 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
820 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
821 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
822 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
823
824tune.sndbuf.client <number>
825tune.sndbuf.server <number>
826 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
827 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
828 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
829 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
830 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
831 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
832 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
833 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
834 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
835 notifying haproxy again.
836
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100837tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
838 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
839 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
840 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
841 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
842 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
843
844tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
845 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
846 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
847 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
848 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008503.3. Debugging
851--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852
853debug
854 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
855 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
856 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
857 system startup.
858
859quiet
860 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
861 line argument "-q".
862
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008643.4. Userlists
865--------------
866It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
867http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
868it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
869
870userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100871 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100872 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
873
874group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100875 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100876 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
877 proceeded by "users" keyword.
878
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100879user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
880 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100881 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
882 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100883 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
884 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100885 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
886 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
887
888
889 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100890 userlist L1
891 group G1 users tiger,scott
892 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100893
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100894 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
895 user scott insecure-password elgato
896 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100897
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100898 userlist L2
899 group G1
900 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100901
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100902 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
903 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
904 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100905
906 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200908
9093.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200910----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200911It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
912haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
913pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
914identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
915or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
916Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
917known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
918the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
919process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
920during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
921tables.
922
923peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400924 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200925 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
926
927peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
928 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
929 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
930 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
931 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
932 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
933 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
934
935 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
936 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
937
938 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
939 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
940 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
941 across all peers.
942
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200943 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200944 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100945 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
946 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
947 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200948
949 backend mybackend
950 mode tcp
951 balance roundrobin
952 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
953 stick on src
954
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100955 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
956 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200957
958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009594. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200960----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
963 - defaults <name>
964 - frontend <name>
965 - backend <name>
966 - listen <name>
967
968A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
969its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
970section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100971section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972
973A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
974connections.
975
976A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
977to forward incoming connections.
978
979A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
980parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100982All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
983'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
984case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
985
986Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
987logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
988proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
989However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
990name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
991
992Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
993and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100994bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100995protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
996modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
997arbitrary criteria.
998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010004.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1001--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001003The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1004limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1005they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1006limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001007marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001008option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001009and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1010with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1011specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001012
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001013
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001014 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1015------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1016acl - X X X
1017appsession - - X X
1018backlog X X X -
1019balance X - X X
1020bind - X X -
1021bind-process X X X X
1022block - X X X
1023capture cookie - X X -
1024capture request header - X X -
1025capture response header - X X -
1026clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001027compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001028contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1029cookie X - X X
1030default-server X - X X
1031default_backend X X X -
1032description - X X X
1033disabled X X X X
1034dispatch - - X X
1035enabled X X X X
1036errorfile X X X X
1037errorloc X X X X
1038errorloc302 X X X X
1039-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1040errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001041force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001042fullconn X - X X
1043grace X X X X
1044hash-type X - X X
1045http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001046http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001047http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001048http-request - X X X
1049id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001050ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001051log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001052maxconn X X X -
1053mode X X X X
1054monitor fail - X X -
1055monitor-net X X X -
1056monitor-uri X X X -
1057option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1058option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1059option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1060option allbackups (*) X - X X
1061option checkcache (*) X - X X
1062option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1063option contstats (*) X X X -
1064option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1065option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1066option forceclose (*) X X X X
1067-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1068option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001069option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001070option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001071option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1072option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1073option httpchk X - X X
1074option httpclose (*) X X X X
1075option httplog X X X X
1076option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001077option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001078option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001079option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1080option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1081option logasap (*) X X X -
1082option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001083option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001084option nolinger (*) X X X X
1085option originalto X X X X
1086option persist (*) X - X X
1087option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001088option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001089option smtpchk X - X X
1090option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1091option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1092option splice-request (*) X X X X
1093option splice-response (*) X X X X
1094option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1095option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1096-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1097option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1098option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1099option tcpka X X X X
1100option tcplog X X X X
1101option transparent (*) X - X X
1102persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1103rate-limit sessions X X X -
1104redirect - X X X
1105redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1106redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1107reqadd - X X X
1108reqallow - X X X
1109reqdel - X X X
1110reqdeny - X X X
1111reqiallow - X X X
1112reqidel - X X X
1113reqideny - X X X
1114reqipass - X X X
1115reqirep - X X X
1116reqisetbe - X X X
1117reqitarpit - X X X
1118reqpass - X X X
1119reqrep - X X X
1120-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1121reqsetbe - X X X
1122reqtarpit - X X X
1123retries X - X X
1124rspadd - X X X
1125rspdel - X X X
1126rspdeny - X X X
1127rspidel - X X X
1128rspideny - X X X
1129rspirep - X X X
1130rsprep - X X X
1131server - - X X
1132source X - X X
1133srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001134stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001135stats auth X - X X
1136stats enable X - X X
1137stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001138stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139stats realm X - X X
1140stats refresh X - X X
1141stats scope X - X X
1142stats show-desc X - X X
1143stats show-legends X - X X
1144stats show-node X - X X
1145stats uri X - X X
1146-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1147stick match - - X X
1148stick on - - X X
1149stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001150stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001152tcp-request connection - X X -
1153tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001154tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001155tcp-response content - - X X
1156tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001157timeout check X - X X
1158timeout client X X X -
1159timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1160timeout connect X - X X
1161timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1162timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1163timeout http-request X X X X
1164timeout queue X - X X
1165timeout server X - X X
1166timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1167timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001168timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001170unique-id-format X X X -
1171unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001172use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001173use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001174------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1175 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1179---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001180
1181This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1182
1183
1184acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1185 Declare or complete an access list.
1186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1187 no | yes | yes | yes
1188 Example:
1189 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1190 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1191 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001193 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001194
1195
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001196appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1197 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001198 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1200 no | no | yes | yes
1201 Arguments :
1202 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1203 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1204
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001205 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001206 checked in each cookie value.
1207
1208 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1209 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1210 milliseconds.
1211
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001212 request-learn
1213 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1214 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1215 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1216 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1217 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1218 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1219
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001220 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1221 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1222 data following this prefix.
1223
1224 Example :
1225 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1226
1227 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1228 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1229
1230 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1231 2 modes are currently supported :
1232 - path-parameters :
1233 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1234 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1235 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1236 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1237 - query-string :
1238 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1239 query string.
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1242 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1243 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1244 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001245 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1246 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1247 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001248 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1249 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1250
1251 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1252
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001253 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1254 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1255 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001257 Example :
1258 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1259
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001260 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1261 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
1263
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001264backlog <conns>
1265 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1267 yes | yes | yes | no
1268 Arguments :
1269 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1270 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001271 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001272
1273 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1274 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1275 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1276 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1277 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1278 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1279 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1280 backlog parameter.
1281
1282 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1283 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1284 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1285
1286 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1287
1288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001289balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001290balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1293 yes | no | yes | yes
1294 Arguments :
1295 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1296 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1297 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1298 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1299
1300 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1301 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1302 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1303 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001304 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1305 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1306 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1307 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1308 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1309 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1310 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1311 it, so that you don't worry.
1312
1313 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1314 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1315 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1316 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1317 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1318 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1319 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1320 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001321
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001322 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1323 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1324 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1325 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1326 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1327 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1328 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1329 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1330
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001331 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1332 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1333 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1334 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001335 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001336 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1337 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1338 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1339 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1340 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001341 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1342 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1343 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1344 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1345 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1346 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001348 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1349 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1350 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1351 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1352 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1353 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1354 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1355 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001356 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001358 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1359 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1360 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001362 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1363 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1364 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1365 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1366 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1367 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1368 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1369 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1370 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1371 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1372 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1373 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001374
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001375 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001376 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1377 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1378 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1379 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1380 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1381 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1382 URIs start with a leading "/".
1383
1384 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1385 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1386 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1387 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001390 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1391
1392 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001393 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1394 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1395 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1396 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1397 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1398 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1399 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1400 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1401 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1402 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1403 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1404 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1405 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1406 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1407 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1408 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1409 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1410 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1411 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001412
1413 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1414 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1415 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1416 server will receive the request.
1417
1418 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1419 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1420 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1421 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1422 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001423 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1424 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1425 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001427 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1428 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1429 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1430 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1431 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001433 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001434 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1435 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1436 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1437
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001438 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1439 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1440 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1441
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001442 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001443 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001444 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1445 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1446 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1447 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1448 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1449 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001450 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001451 used instead.
1452
1453 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1454 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1455 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1456 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1457
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001458 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1459 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1460 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1461
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001462 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001465 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1466 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001467
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001468 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001469 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001471 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1472 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1473 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474
1475 Examples :
1476 balance roundrobin
1477 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001478 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001479 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1480 balance hdr(host)
1481 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001482
1483 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1484 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001486 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001487 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1488 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1489 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1490 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1491
1492 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1493 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1494 defaults to 16 kB.
1495
1496 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1497 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1498
1499 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1500 Round Robin.
1501
1502 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1503 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1504 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1505 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1506
1507 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1508
1509 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001510 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001511 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1512 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1513 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001514
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001515 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1516 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001517
1518
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001519bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1520bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001521 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1523 no | yes | yes | no
1524 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001525 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1526 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1527 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1528 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001529 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001530
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001531 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1532 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001533 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1534 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1535 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001536 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1537 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1538 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1539 the range.
1540
1541 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1542 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1543 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1544 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1545 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1546 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1547 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001548 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001549 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001551 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1552 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1553 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1554 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1555 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1556 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1557 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1558 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1559
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001560 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1561 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1562 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1563 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1566 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1567 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1568 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1569 in a frontend.
1570
1571 Example :
1572 listen http_proxy
1573 bind :80,:443
1574 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001575 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001577 listen http_https_proxy
1578 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001579 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001580
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001581 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001582 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001583
1584
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001585bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1586 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1588 yes | yes | yes | yes
1589 Arguments :
1590 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1591 may be used to override a default value.
1592
1593 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1594 option may be combined with other numbers.
1595
1596 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1597 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1598 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1599 missing from all processes.
1600
1601 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1602 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1603 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1604 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1605
1606 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1607 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1608 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1609 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1610 and 'even' instances.
1611
1612 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1613 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1614 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1615 32.
1616
1617 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1618 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1619
1620 Example :
1621 listen app_ip1
1622 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001623 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001624
1625 listen app_ip2
1626 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001627 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001628
1629 listen management
1630 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001631 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001632
1633 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1634
1635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636block { if | unless } <condition>
1637 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1639 no | yes | yes | yes
1640
1641 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1642 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001643 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001644 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1646 "block" statements per instance.
1647
1648 Example:
1649 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1650 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1651 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1652 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001654 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
1656
1657capture cookie <name> len <length>
1658 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1660 no | yes | yes | no
1661 Arguments :
1662 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1663 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1664 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1665 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1666 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1667
1668 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1669 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1670 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1671 right if it exceeds <length>.
1672
1673 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1674 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1675 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1676 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1677
1678 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1679 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1680 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1681
1682 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1683 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1684 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1685 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001686 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001687 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1688
1689 Example:
1690 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1691
1692 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001693 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694
1695
1696capture request header <name> len <length>
1697 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1699 no | yes | yes | no
1700 Arguments :
1701 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001702 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001703 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1704 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1705 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1706
1707 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1708 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1709 it exceeds <length>.
1710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001711 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001712 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1713 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001714 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1715 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1716 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1717 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001718 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001719 environments to find where the request came from.
1720
1721 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1722 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1723 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1724 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001725
1726 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1727 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1728 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1729 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1730
1731 Example:
1732 capture request header Host len 15
1733 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1734 capture request header Referrer len 15
1735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001736 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737 about logging.
1738
1739
1740capture response header <name> len <length>
1741 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1743 no | yes | yes | no
1744 Arguments :
1745 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001746 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1748 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1749 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1750
1751 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1752 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1753 it exceeds <length>.
1754
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001755 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001756 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1757 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1758 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001759 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1760 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1761 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1762 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001763
1764 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1765 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1766 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1767 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1768
1769 Example:
1770 capture response header Content-length len 9
1771 capture response header Location len 15
1772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001773 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774 about logging.
1775
1776
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001777clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1780 yes | yes | yes | no
1781 Arguments :
1782 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1783 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1784 as explained at the top of this document.
1785
1786 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1787 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1788 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1789 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1790 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1791 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1792 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1793 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001794 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1796 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1797
1798 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1799 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1800 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1801 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1802 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1803 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1804
1805 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1806 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1807
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001808 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1809 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001811compression algo <algorithm> ...
1812compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001813compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001814 Enable HTTP compression.
1815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1816 yes | yes | yes | yes
1817 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001818 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1819 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1820 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1821
1822 The currently supported algorithms are :
1823 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developping
1824 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1825 data.
1826
1827 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1828 support for zlib was built in.
1829
1830 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1831 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1832 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1833 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1834 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1835 in.
1836
1837 Compression will be activated depending of the Accept-Encoding request
1838 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001839
1840 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1841 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1842 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1843 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1844 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1845 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1846 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1847 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1848 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001849
1850 Examples :
1851 compression algo gzip
1852 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001854contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001855 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1857 yes | no | yes | yes
1858 Arguments :
1859 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1861 as explained at the top of this document.
1862
1863 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001864 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001865 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1867 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1868 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1869 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1870
1871 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1872 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1873 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1874 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1875 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1876 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1877
1878 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1879 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1880 instead.
1881
1882 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1883 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1884
1885
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001886cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001887 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1888 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1891 yes | no | yes | yes
1892 Arguments :
1893 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1894 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1895 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1896 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1897 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1898 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1899 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1900 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1901 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1902
1903 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1904 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1905 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1906 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1907 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1908 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1909 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1910 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1911 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1912 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1913 "insert" and "prefix".
1914
1915 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001916 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001917
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001918 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001919 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1920 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1921 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1922 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1923 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1924 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1925 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1926 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1927 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1928 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929
1930 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1931 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1932 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1933 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1934 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1935 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1936 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1937 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1938 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1939 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001940 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1941 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1942 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001944 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1945 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1946 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001947 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1948 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1949 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1950 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001951 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1952 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1953 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
1955 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1956 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1957 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1958 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1959 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1960 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1961 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1962 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1963 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1964
1965 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1966 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1967 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1968 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1969 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1970 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1971 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1972 persistence cookie in the cache.
1973 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1974
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001975 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1976 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1977 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1978 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1979 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1980 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1981 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1982 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1983 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1984 they logout.
1985
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001986 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1987 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1988 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1989 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1990
1991 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1992 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1993 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1994 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1995 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1996 this attribute.
1997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001998 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001999 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002000 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2001 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2002 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2003 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2004 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2005 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002006
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002007 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2008 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2009 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2010 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2011 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2012 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2013 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2014 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2015 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2016 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2017 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2018 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2019 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2020 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2021 the site.
2022
2023 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2024 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2025 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2026 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2027 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2028 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2029 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2030 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2031 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2032 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2033 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2034 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2035 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2036 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2037 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2038 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2041 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2042 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2043 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 Examples :
2046 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2047 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2048 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002049 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002051 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002052 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002055default-server [param*]
2056 Change default options for a server in a backend
2057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 yes | no | yes | yes
2059 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002060 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2061 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2062 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2063 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002064
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002065 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002066 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2067
2068 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002069
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071default_backend <backend>
2072 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2074 yes | yes | yes | no
2075 Arguments :
2076 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2077
2078 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2079 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2080 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2081 will catch all undetermined requests.
2082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 Example :
2084
2085 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2086 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2087 default_backend dynamic
2088
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002089 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091
2092disabled
2093 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2095 yes | yes | yes | yes
2096 Arguments : none
2097
2098 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2099 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2100 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2101 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2102 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2103 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2104 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2105
2106 See also : "enabled"
2107
2108
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002109dispatch <address>:<port>
2110 Set a default server address
2111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2112 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002113 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002114
2115 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2116 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2117 during start-up.
2118
2119 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2120 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2121 possible with normal servers.
2122
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002123 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002124 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2125 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2126 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2127 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2128
2129 See also : "server"
2130
2131
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002132enabled
2133 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2135 yes | yes | yes | yes
2136 Arguments : none
2137
2138 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2139 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2140
2141 See also : "disabled"
2142
2143
2144errorfile <code> <file>
2145 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2147 yes | yes | yes | yes
2148 Arguments :
2149 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002150 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151
2152 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002153 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002155 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2156 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
2158 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2159 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2160 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2161
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002162 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002164 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2165 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2166 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2167 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2168
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002169 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2170 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2171 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2172 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2173 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2174 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2175
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002176 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2177 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2178 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002179 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2181
2182 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2183
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002184 Example :
2185 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2186 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2187 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2188
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002189
2190errorloc <code> <url>
2191errorloc302 <code> <url>
2192 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2194 yes | yes | yes | yes
2195 Arguments :
2196 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002197 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002198
2199 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2200 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2201 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2202 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2203 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2204
2205 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2206 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2207 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2208
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002209 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2210
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002211 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2212 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2213 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2214 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2215 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2216 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2217 request.
2218
2219 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2220
2221
2222errorloc303 <code> <url>
2223 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2225 yes | yes | yes | yes
2226 Arguments :
2227 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2228 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2229
2230 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2231 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2232 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2233 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2234 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2235
2236 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2237 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2238 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2239
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002240 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2241
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002242 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2243 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2244 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2245 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002246 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002247
2248 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2249
2250
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002251force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2252 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2254 no | yes | yes | yes
2255
2256 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2257 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2258 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2259 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2260 marked down for maintenance operations.
2261
2262 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2263 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2264 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2265 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2266 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2267 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2268 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2269 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2270 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2271
2272 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2273 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2274 is used.
2275
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002276 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002277 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002278
2279
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002280fullconn <conns>
2281 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2283 yes | no | yes | yes
2284 Arguments :
2285 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2286 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2287
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002288 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002289 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002290 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002291 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2292 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2293 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2294 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2295 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002296 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002297
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002298 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2299 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2300 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002302 Example :
2303 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2304 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2305 # connections.
2306 backend dynamic
2307 fullconn 10000
2308 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2309 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2310
2311 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2312
2313
2314grace <time>
2315 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002317 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002318 Arguments :
2319 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2320 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2321 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2322
2323 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2324 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002325 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002326 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2327
2328 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2329 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2330 simplify it.
2331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002333hash-type <method>
2334 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2336 yes | no | yes | yes
2337 Arguments :
2338 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2339 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2340 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2341 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2342 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2343 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2344 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2345 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2346 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2347
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002348 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2349 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2350 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2351 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2352 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2353 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2354 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2355 this value.
2356
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002357 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2358 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2359 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2360 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2361 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2362 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2363 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2364 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2365 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2366 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2367 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2368 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2369 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2370
2371 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2372
2373 See also : "balance", "server"
2374
2375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376http-check disable-on-404
2377 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002379 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380 Arguments : none
2381
2382 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2383 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2384 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2385 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2386 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2387 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2388 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2389 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002390 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2391 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2392 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2393
2394 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2395
2396
2397http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002398 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002400 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002401 Arguments :
2402 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2403 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002404 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002405 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2406 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2407 details on the supported keywords.
2408
2409 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2410 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2411 with the usual backslash ('\').
2412
2413 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2414 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2415 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2416 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2417 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2418
2419 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002420 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002421 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2422 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2423 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2424
2425 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002426 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002427 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2428 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2429 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2430 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2431
2432 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002433 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002434 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2435 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2436 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2437 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2438 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2439 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2440 trace).
2441
2442 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002443 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002444 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2445 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2446 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2447 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2448 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2449 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2450
2451 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2452 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2453 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2454 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2455 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2456 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2457 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2458 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2459
2460 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2461 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2462
2463 Examples :
2464 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002465 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002466
2467 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002468 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002469
2470 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002471 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002472
2473 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002474 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002475
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002476 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002477
2478
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002479http-check send-state
2480 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2482 yes | no | yes | yes
2483 Arguments : none
2484
2485 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2486 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2487 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2488 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2489 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2490
2491 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2492 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2493 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2494 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2495 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2496 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2497 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2498 checked in multiple backends.
2499
2500 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2501 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2502
2503 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2504 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2505 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2506 one fails.
2507
2508 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2509 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2510 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2511
2512 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2513 server's queue.
2514
2515 Example of a header received by the application server :
2516 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2517 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2518
2519 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2520
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002521http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002522 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002523 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2524
2525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2526 no | yes | yes | yes
2527
2528 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2529 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2530 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002531 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2532 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002533 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2534
2535 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2536 instance.
2537
2538 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002539 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2540 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2541 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002542
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002543 http-request allow if nagios
2544 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2545 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2546 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002547
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002548 Example:
2549 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002550
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002551 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002552
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002553 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2554 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002555
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002556http-send-name-header [<header>]
2557 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2558
2559 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 yes | no | yes | yes
2561
2562 Arguments :
2563
2564 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2565
2566 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2567 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2568 is added with the header string proved.
2569
2570 See also : "server"
2571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002572id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002573 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2575 no | yes | yes | yes
2576 Arguments : none
2577
2578 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2579 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2580 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002581
2582
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002583ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2584 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2586 no | yes | yes | yes
2587
2588 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2589 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2590 and running).
2591
2592 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2593 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2594 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2595 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2596 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2597
2598 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2599 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2600
2601 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2602 "unless" condition is met.
2603
2604 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2605
2606
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002607log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002608log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002609no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002610 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002613
2614 Prefix :
2615 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2616 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2617 prefix does not allow arguments.
2618
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002619 Arguments :
2620 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2621 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2622 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2623 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2624 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2625 parameter.
2626
2627 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2628 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2629
2630 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2631 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2632 standard syslog port).
2633
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002634 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2635 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2636 standard syslog port).
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2639 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2640 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2641 appropriately writeable).
2642
2643 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2644
2645 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2646 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2647 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2648
2649 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2650 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2651 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002652 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2653 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2654 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2655 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2656 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002657
2658 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2659
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002660 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2661 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2662 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002663
2664 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2665 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2666 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2667 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2668
2669 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2670 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671
2672 Example :
2673 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002674 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2675 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002677log-format <string>
2678 Allows you to custom a log line.
2679
2680 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2681
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002682
2683maxconn <conns>
2684 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2686 yes | yes | yes | no
2687 Arguments :
2688 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2689 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2690 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2691 closes.
2692
2693 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2694 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2695 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2696 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2697 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2698 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2699 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2700 properly tuned.
2701
2702 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2703 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2704 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2705
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002706 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002708 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2709
2710
2711mode { tcp|http|health }
2712 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2714 yes | yes | yes | yes
2715 Arguments :
2716 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2717 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2718 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2719 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2720
2721 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2722 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2723 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2724 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2725 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2726
2727 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002728 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2729 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2730 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2731 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2732 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2733 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2734 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002735
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002736 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2737 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2738 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002739
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002740 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002741 defaults http_instances
2742 mode http
2743
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002744 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002747monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002748 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2750 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751 Arguments :
2752 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2753 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002754 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002755 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2756 backend and its backup.
2757
2758 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2759 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2760 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2761 servers in a list of backends.
2762
2763 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2764 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2765 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2766 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2767 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2768 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2769 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002770 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2771 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002772
2773 Example:
2774 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002775 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002776 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2777 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2778 monitor-uri /site_alive
2779 monitor fail if site_dead
2780
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002781 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002782
2783
2784monitor-net <source>
2785 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2787 yes | yes | yes | no
2788 Arguments :
2789 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2790 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2791 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2792 followed by a mask.
2793
2794 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2795 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002796 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002797 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2798
2799 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2800 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2801 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2802 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002803 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2804 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2805 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002806
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002807 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2808 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2809 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2810 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2811 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2812 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002813
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002814 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2815 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002817 Example :
2818 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2819 frontend www
2820 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2821
2822 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2823
2824
2825monitor-uri <uri>
2826 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments :
2830 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2831 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2832
2833 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2834 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2835 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2836 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2837 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2838 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2839 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2840 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2841
2842 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2843 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2844 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2845 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2846 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2847 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2848
2849 Example :
2850 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2851 frontend www
2852 mode http
2853 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2854
2855 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002858option abortonclose
2859no option abortonclose
2860 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2862 yes | no | yes | yes
2863 Arguments : none
2864
2865 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2866 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2867 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2868 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002869 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002870 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2871 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2872 encountered while delivering the response.
2873
2874 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2875 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2876 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2877 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2878 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2879 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002880 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002881 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002882 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002883 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2884 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2885 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2886
2887 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2888 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2889 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2890 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2891 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2892 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2893 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2894 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002895 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002896
2897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2899
2900 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2901
2902
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002903option accept-invalid-http-request
2904no option accept-invalid-http-request
2905 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2907 yes | yes | yes | no
2908 Arguments : none
2909
2910 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2911 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2912 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2913 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2914 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2915 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2916 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2917 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002918 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2919 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2920 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2921 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2922 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2923 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002924
2925 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2926 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2927 been confirmed.
2928
2929 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2930 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002931 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2932 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002933 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2934
2935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2937
2938 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2939 stats socket.
2940
2941
2942option accept-invalid-http-response
2943no option accept-invalid-http-response
2944 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | no | yes | yes
2947 Arguments : none
2948
2949 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2950 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2951 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2952 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2953 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2954 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2955 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2956 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2957 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2958
2959 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2960 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2961 been confirmed.
2962
2963 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2964 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2965 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2966 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2967
2968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2970
2971 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2972 stats socket.
2973
2974
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002975option allbackups
2976no option allbackups
2977 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2979 yes | no | yes | yes
2980 Arguments : none
2981
2982 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2983 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2984 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2985 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2986 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2987 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2988 order between the backup servers anymore.
2989
2990 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2991 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2992
2993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2995
2996
2997option checkcache
2998no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002999 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3001 yes | no | yes | yes
3002 Arguments : none
3003
3004 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3005 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003006 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003007 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3008 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003009 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003010
3011 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003012 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003013 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003014 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3015 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003016 to the client are :
3017 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003019 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003020 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3021 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3022 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3023 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3024 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3025 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3026 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3027 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3028 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3029 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3030 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3031
3032 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003033 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003034 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003035 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003036 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3037
3038 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3039 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003040 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003041 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3042
3043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3045
3046
3047option clitcpka
3048no option clitcpka
3049 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3051 yes | yes | yes | no
3052 Arguments : none
3053
3054 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3055 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3056 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3057 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3058
3059 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3060 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3061 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3062 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3063
3064 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3065 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3066 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3067 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3068 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3069
3070 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3071
3072 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3073 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3074 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3075
3076 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3077 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3078
3079 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3080
3081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082option contstats
3083 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 yes | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments : none
3087
3088 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3089 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3090 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3091 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3092 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3093 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3094 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3095
3096
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003097option dontlog-normal
3098no option dontlog-normal
3099 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3101 yes | yes | yes | no
3102 Arguments : none
3103
3104 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3105 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3106 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3107 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3108 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3109 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3110 logged.
3111
3112 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3113 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3114 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003116 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003117 logging.
3118
3119
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003120option dontlognull
3121no option dontlognull
3122 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | no
3125 Arguments : none
3126
3127 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3128 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3129 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3130 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3131 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3132 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3133 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3134
3135 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3136 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3137 would not be logged.
3138
3139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003142 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003143
3144
3145option forceclose
3146no option forceclose
3147 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003149 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003150 Arguments : none
3151
3152 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3153 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3154 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3155 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3156 global session times in the logs.
3157
3158 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003159 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003160 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3161 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3162 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3163 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003164
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003165 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3166 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3167 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3168
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3171
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003172 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003173
3174
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003175option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003176 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3178 yes | yes | yes | yes
3179 Arguments :
3180 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3181 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003182 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003183 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003184
3185 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3186 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3187 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3188 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3189 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3190 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3191 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003192 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3193 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3194 possible that the client has already brought one.
3195
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003196 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003197 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003198 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3199 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003200 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3201 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003202
3203 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3204 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3205 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3206 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3207 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3208 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3209 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3210
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003211 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3212 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3213 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3214 are under the control of the end-user.
3215
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003216 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003217 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3218 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003219 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3220 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3221 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003222
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003223 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3224 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3225 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3226 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3227 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003228
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003229 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003230 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3231 frontend www
3232 mode http
3233 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3234
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003235 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3236 backend www
3237 mode http
3238 option forwardfor header X-Client
3239
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003240 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3241 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003242
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003243
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003244option http-no-delay
3245no option http-no-delay
3246 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3248 yes | yes | yes | yes
3249 Arguments : none
3250
3251 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3252 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3253 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3254 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3255 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3256 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3257 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3258 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3259 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3260 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3261 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3262 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3263 affected.
3264
3265 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3266 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3267 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3268 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3269 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3270 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3271 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3272 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3273 latency environments.
3274
3275
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003276option http-pretend-keepalive
3277no option http-pretend-keepalive
3278 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | yes | yes | yes
3281 Arguments : none
3282
3283 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3284 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3285 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3286 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3287 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3288 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3289 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3290 consider the response complete.
3291
3292 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3293 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3294 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3295 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3296 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3297 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3298
3299 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3300 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3301 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3302 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3303 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3304 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3305 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3306
3307 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3308 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003309 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003310 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3311 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003312
3313 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3314 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3315
3316 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3317
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003318
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003319option http-server-close
3320no option http-server-close
3321 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 yes | yes | yes | yes
3324 Arguments : none
3325
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003326 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3327 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3328 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3329 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3330 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3331 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3332 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3333 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3334 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3335 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3336 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3337 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003338
3339 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3340 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3341 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3342 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003343 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3344 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003345
3346 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3347 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003348 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3349 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3350 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003351
3352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3354
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003355 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3356 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003357
3358
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003359option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003360no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003361 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3363 yes | yes | yes | no
3364 Arguments : none
3365
3366 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3367 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3368 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3369 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3370 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3371 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3372 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3373
3374 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3375 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3376 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3377 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3378 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3379 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3380 request along its whole life.
3381
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003382 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3383 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3384 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3385 front of an existing proxy.
3386
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003387 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3388
3389 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3390 http-server-close".
3391
3392
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003393option httpchk
3394option httpchk <uri>
3395option httpchk <method> <uri>
3396option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3397 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | no | yes | yes
3400 Arguments :
3401 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3402 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3403 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3404 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3405 ones.
3406
3407 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3408 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3409 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3410
3411 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3412 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3413 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3414 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3415 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3416
3417 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3418 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3419 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3420 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3421 the lack of any response.
3422
3423 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3424
3425 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3426 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3427 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3428
3429 Examples :
3430 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3431 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3432 backend https_relay
3433 mode tcp
3434 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3435 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3436
3437 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003438 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3439 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003440
3441
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003442option httpclose
3443no option httpclose
3444 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | yes
3447 Arguments : none
3448
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003449 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3450 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3451 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3452 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3453 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3454 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3455 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003456
3457 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003458 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003459 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3460 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3461 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3462 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3463 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003464
3465 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3466 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3467 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003468 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3469 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003470
3471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3473
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003474 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3475 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003476
3477
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003478option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003479 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3481 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003482 Arguments :
3483 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3484 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3485 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3486 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3487 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003488
3489 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3490 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3491 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3492 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3493 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3494 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3495 ports.
3496
3497 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3498
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3501 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3502 by default.
3503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003504 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003505
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003506
3507option http_proxy
3508no option http_proxy
3509 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3511 yes | yes | yes | yes
3512 Arguments : none
3513
3514 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3515 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3516 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3517 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3518 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3519
3520 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3521 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3522 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3523 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003524 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003525 be analyzed.
3526
3527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3529
3530 Example :
3531 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3532 backend direct_forward
3533 option httpclose
3534 option http_proxy
3535
3536 See also : "option httpclose"
3537
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003538
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003539option independent-streams
3540no option independent-streams
3541 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 yes | yes | yes | yes
3544 Arguments : none
3545
3546 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3547 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3548 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3549 receive data or not.
3550
3551 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3552 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3553 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3554 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3555 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3556 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3557 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3558 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3559 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3560 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3561 socket buffers.
3562
3563 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3564 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3565 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3566 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3567 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3568
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003569 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3570 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3571 deprecated.
3572
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003573 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003574
3575
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003576option ldap-check
3577 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | no | yes | yes
3580 Arguments : none
3581
3582 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3583 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3584 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3585 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3586
3587 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3588 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3589
3590 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3591 configure it.
3592
3593 Example :
3594 option ldap-check
3595
3596 See also : "option httpchk"
3597
3598
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003599option log-health-checks
3600no option log-health-checks
3601 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | no | yes | yes
3604 Arguments : none
3605
3606 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3607 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3608 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3609 of additional information is limited.
3610
3611 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3612 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3613
3614 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3615
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003616
3617option log-separate-errors
3618no option log-separate-errors
3619 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3621 yes | yes | yes | no
3622 Arguments : none
3623
3624 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3625 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3626 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3627 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3628 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3629 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3630 provides very important information.
3631
3632 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3633 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3634 error logs.
3635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003636 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003637 logging.
3638
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003639
3640option logasap
3641no option logasap
3642 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3644 yes | yes | yes | no
3645 Arguments : none
3646
3647 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3648 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3649 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3650 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3651 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3652 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3653 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003654 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003655 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3656 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003658 Examples :
3659 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3660 mode http
3661 option httplog
3662 option logasap
3663 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3664
3665 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3666 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3667 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3668 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003670 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003671 logging.
3672
3673
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003674option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3675 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3677 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003678 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003679 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3680 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003681
3682 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3683 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3684 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3685 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3686 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3687 in the MySQL table, like this :
3688
3689 USE mysql;
3690 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3691 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3692
3693 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3694 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3695 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3696 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3697 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3698 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3699 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3700 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3701 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3702
3703 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3704 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003705
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003706 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003707
3708 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3709 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3710 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3711 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3712 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3713 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3714
3715 See also: "option httpchk"
3716
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003717option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3718 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 yes | no | yes | yes
3721 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003722 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3723 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003724
3725 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3726 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3727 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3728 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3729
3730 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003731
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003732option nolinger
3733no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003734 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003737 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003738
3739 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3740 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3741 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3742 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3743 connections.
3744
3745 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3746 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3747 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3748 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3749 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3750 this too.
3751
3752 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3753 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3754 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3755
3756 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3757 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3758 for servers.
3759
3760 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3761 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3762
3763
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003764option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3765 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3767 yes | yes | yes | yes
3768 Arguments :
3769 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3770 matching <network>
3771 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3772 header name.
3773
3774 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3775 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3776 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3777 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3778 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3779 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3780 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3781 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3782 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3783 possible that the client has already brought one.
3784
3785 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3786 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3787 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3788 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3789 header and requires different one.
3790
3791 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3792 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3793 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3794 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3795 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3796 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3797 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3798
3799 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3800 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3801 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3802 both are defined.
3803
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003804 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3805 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3806 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3807 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3808 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003809
3810 Examples :
3811 # Original Destination address
3812 frontend www
3813 mode http
3814 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3815
3816 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3817 backend www
3818 mode http
3819 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3820
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003821 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3822 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003823
3824
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003825option persist
3826no option persist
3827 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3829 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003830 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003831
3832 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3833 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3834 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3835 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3836 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3837 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3838 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3839 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3840 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3841 redirected to another valid server.
3842
3843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3845
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003846 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003847
3848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003849option redispatch
3850no option redispatch
3851 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003854 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003855
3856 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3857 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3858 be able to access the service anymore.
3859
3860 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3861 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3862
3863 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3864 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3865 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003867 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3868 "redisp" keywords.
3869
3870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3872
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003873 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003874
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003875
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003876option redis-check
3877 Use redis health checks for server testing
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | no | yes | yes
3880 Arguments : none
3881
3882 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3883 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3884 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3885 find the "+PONG" response message.
3886
3887 Example :
3888 option redis-check
3889
3890 See also : "option httpchk"
3891
3892
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003893option smtpchk
3894option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3895 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3897 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003898 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003899 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3900 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3901 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3902
3903 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3904 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3905 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3906
3907 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3908 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3909 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3910 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3911 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3912 dead server.
3913
3914 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3915 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3916 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3917 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3918
3919 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3920 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3921 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3922 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3923 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3924
3925 Example :
3926 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3927
3928 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003931option socket-stats
3932no option socket-stats
3933
3934 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3936 yes | yes | yes | no
3937
3938 Arguments : none
3939
3940
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003941option splice-auto
3942no option splice-auto
3943 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | yes | yes | yes
3946 Arguments : none
3947
3948 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3949 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3950 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3951 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003952 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003953 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3954 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3955 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3956 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3957
3958 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3959 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3960 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3961 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3962 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3963 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3964 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3965 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3966 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3967 keyword.
3968
3969 Example :
3970 option splice-auto
3971
3972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3974
3975 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3976 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3977
3978
3979option splice-request
3980no option splice-request
3981 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3983 yes | yes | yes | yes
3984 Arguments : none
3985
3986 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003987 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003988 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3989 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3990 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3991 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3992
3993 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3994
3995 Example :
3996 option splice-request
3997
3998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4000
4001 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4002 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4003
4004
4005option splice-response
4006no option splice-response
4007 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | yes | yes | yes
4010 Arguments : none
4011
4012 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004013 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004014 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4015 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4016 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4017 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4018
4019 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4020
4021 Example :
4022 option splice-response
4023
4024 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4025 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4026
4027 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4028 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4029
4030
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004031option srvtcpka
4032no option srvtcpka
4033 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4035 yes | no | yes | yes
4036 Arguments : none
4037
4038 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4039 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4040 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4041 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4042
4043 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4044 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4045 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4046 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4047
4048 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4049 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4050 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4051 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4052 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4053
4054 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4055
4056 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4057 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4058 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4059
4060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4062
4063 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4064
4065
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004066option ssl-hello-chk
4067 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4069 yes | no | yes | yes
4070 Arguments : none
4071
4072 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4073 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4074 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4075 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4076 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4077 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4078 hello message.
4079
4080 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4081 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4082 messages, which is appreciable.
4083
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004084 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4085 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4086 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004087
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004088 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4089
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004090
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004091option tcp-smart-accept
4092no option tcp-smart-accept
4093 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 yes | yes | yes | no
4096 Arguments : none
4097
4098 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4099 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4100 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4101 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4102 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4103 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4104
4105 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4106 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4107 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4108 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4109
4110 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4111 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4112 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4113 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4114
4115 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4116 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4117 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4118
4119 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4120 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4121 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4122
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004123 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4124
4125
4126option tcp-smart-connect
4127no option tcp-smart-connect
4128 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | no | yes | yes
4131 Arguments : none
4132
4133 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4134 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4135 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4136 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4137 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4138
4139 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4140 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4141 complex.
4142
4143 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4144 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4145 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4146
4147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4149
4150 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4151
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004152
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004153option tcpka
4154 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4156 yes | yes | yes | yes
4157 Arguments : none
4158
4159 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4160 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4161 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4162 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4163
4164 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4165 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4166 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4167 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4168
4169 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4170 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4171 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4172 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4173 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4174
4175 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4176
4177 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4178 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4179 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4180 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4181 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4182 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4183 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4184 backends.
4185
4186 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4187
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004188
4189option tcplog
4190 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 yes | yes | yes | yes
4193 Arguments : none
4194
4195 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4196 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4197 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4198 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4199 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4200 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4201 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4202 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4203
4204 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004206 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004207
4208
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004209option transparent
4210no option transparent
4211 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004213 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004214 Arguments : none
4215
4216 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4217 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4218 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4219 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4220 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4221 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4222 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4223 appropriate server.
4224
4225 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4226 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4227
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004228 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004229 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004230
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004231
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004232persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004233persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004234 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4236 yes | no | yes | yes
4237 Arguments :
4238 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004239 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4240 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004241
4242 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4243 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4244 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4245 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4246 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4247 forwarded to this server.
4248
4249 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4250 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4251 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004252 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004253 a single "listen" section.
4254
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004255 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4256 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4257 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4258
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004259 Example :
4260 listen tse-farm
4261 bind :3389
4262 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4263 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4264 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4265 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4266 persist rdp-cookie
4267 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004268 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004269 balance rdp-cookie
4270 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4271 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4272
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004273 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4274 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004275
4276
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004277rate-limit sessions <rate>
4278 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4280 yes | yes | yes | no
4281 Arguments :
4282 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4283 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4284
4285 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4286 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4287 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4288 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4289 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4290 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4291
4292 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4293 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4294 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4295 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4296
4297 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4298 listen smtp
4299 mode tcp
4300 bind :25
4301 rate-limit sessions 10
4302 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4303
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004304 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4305 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4306 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004307
4308 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4309
4310
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004311redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4312redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4313redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004314 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 no | yes | yes | yes
4317
4318 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004319 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004320
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004321 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004322 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4323 the HTTP "Location" header.
4324
4325 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4326 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4327 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4328 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4329 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4330 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4331
4332 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4333 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4334 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4335 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4336 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4337 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4338 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4339 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4340 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004341
4342 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4343 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4344 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4345 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4346 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4347 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4348 location with a GET method.
4349
4350 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4351 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4352
4353 - "drop-query"
4354 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4355 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4356 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4357 with a location-type redirect.
4358
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004359 - "append-slash"
4360 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4361 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4362 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4363 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4364
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004365 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4366 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4367 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4368 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4369 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4370 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4371 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4372
4373 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4374 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4375 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4376 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4377 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4378 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4379 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004380
4381 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4382 acl clear dst_port 80
4383 acl secure dst_port 8080
4384 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004385 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004386 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004387 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4388
4389 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004390 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4391 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4392 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004393 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004394
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004395 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4396 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4397 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4398
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004399 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004400 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004402 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004403
4404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004405redisp (deprecated)
4406redispatch (deprecated)
4407 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4408 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4409 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004410 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004411
4412 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4413 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4414 be able to access the service anymore.
4415
4416 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4417 redistribute them to a working server.
4418
4419 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4420 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4421 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004423 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4424 "option redispatch" instead.
4425
4426 See also : "option redispatch"
4427
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004428
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004429reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004430 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4432 no | yes | yes | yes
4433 Arguments :
4434 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4435 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004436 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004437
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004438 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4439 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4440
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004441 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4442 the last header of an HTTP request.
4443
4444 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4445 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4446 responses.
4447
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004448 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4449 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4450 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4451
4452 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4453 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004454
4455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004456reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4457reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004458 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 no | yes | yes | yes
4461 Arguments :
4462 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4463 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4464 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4465 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4466 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4467 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4468 ignores case.
4469
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004470 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4471 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4472
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004473 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4474 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4475 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4476 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004477 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004478
4479 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4480 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4481
4482 Example :
4483 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4484 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4485 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4486
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004487 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4488 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004489
4490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004491reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4492reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004493 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4495 no | yes | yes | yes
4496 Arguments :
4497 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4498 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4499 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4500 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4501 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4502 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004504 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4505 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4506
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004507 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4508 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4509 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4510 next servers.
4511
4512 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4513 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4514 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4515
4516 Example :
4517 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4518 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4519 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4520
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004521 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4522 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004523
4524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004525reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4526reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 no | yes | yes | yes
4530 Arguments :
4531 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4532 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4533 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4534 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4535 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4536 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4537 case.
4538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004539 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4540 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4541
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004542 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4543 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4544 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4545 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004546 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004547
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004548 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004549 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004550 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004551
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4553 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4554
4555 Example :
4556 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4557 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4558 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004560 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4561 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562
4563
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004564reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4565reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004566 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 no | yes | yes | yes
4569 Arguments :
4570 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4571 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4572 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4573 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4574 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4575 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4576 case.
4577
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004578 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4579 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4580
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004581 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4582 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4583 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4584 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4585
4586 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4587 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4588
4589 Example :
4590 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4591 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4592 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4593 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004595 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4596 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004597
4598
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004599reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4600reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004601 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 no | yes | yes | yes
4604 Arguments :
4605 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4606 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4607 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4608 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4609 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4610 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4611
4612 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4613 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4614 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4615 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004616 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004618 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4619 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4620
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004621 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4622 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4623 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4624
4625 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4626 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4627 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4628 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4629 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4630
4631 Example :
4632 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004633 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004634 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4635 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4636
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004637 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4638 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004639
4640
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004641reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4642reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004643 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 no | yes | yes | yes
4646 Arguments :
4647 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4648 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4649 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4650 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4651 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4652 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4653 ignores case.
4654
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004655 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4656 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4657
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004658 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4659 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004660 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4661 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4662 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004663 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4664 not set.
4665
4666 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4667 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4668 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4669 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4670 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4671
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004672 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004673 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4674 # block all others.
4675 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4676 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4677
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004678 # block bad guys
4679 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4680 reqitarpit . if badguys
4681
4682 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4683 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004684
4685
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004686retries <value>
4687 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4689 yes | no | yes | yes
4690 Arguments :
4691 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4692 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4693 default value is 3.
4694
4695 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4696 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4697 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4698
4699 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4700 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4701
4702 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4703 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4704
4705 See also : "option redispatch"
4706
4707
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004708rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004709 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 no | yes | yes | yes
4712 Arguments :
4713 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4714 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004715 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004716
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004717 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4718 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4719
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004720 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4721 the last header of an HTTP response.
4722
4723 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4724 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4725 responses.
4726
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004727 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4728 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004729
4730
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004731rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4732rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004733 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 no | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments :
4737 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4738 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4739 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4740 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4741 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4742 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4743 ignores case.
4744
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004745 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4746 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4747
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004748 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4749 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004750 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004751 client.
4752
4753 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4754 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4755 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4756
4757 Example :
4758 # remove the Server header from responses
4759 reqidel ^Server:.*
4760
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004761 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4762 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004763
4764
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004765rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4766rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004767 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4769 no | yes | yes | yes
4770 Arguments :
4771 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4772 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4773 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4774 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4775 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4776 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4777 ignores case.
4778
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004779 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4780 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4781
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004782 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4783 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4784 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4785 case-sensitive.
4786
4787 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004788 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4789 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4790 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004791
4792 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4793 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4794
4795 Example :
4796 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4797 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4798
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004799 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4800 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004801
4802
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004803rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4804rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004805 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 no | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4810 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4811 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4812 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4813 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4814 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4815 ignores case.
4816
4817 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4818 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4819 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4820 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004821 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004822
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004823 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4824 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4825
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004826 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4827 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4828 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4829
4830 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4831 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4832 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4833 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4834 are not case-sensitive.
4835
4836 Example :
4837 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4838 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4839
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004840 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4841 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004842
4843
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004844server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004845 Declare a server in a backend
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 no | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments :
4849 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004850 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004851 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004852
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004853 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4854 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4855 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4856 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004857 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4858 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4859 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4860 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4861 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4862 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004863
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004864 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004865 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4866 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4867 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4868 adding this value to the client's port.
4869
4870 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4871 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004872 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004873
4874 Examples :
4875 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4876 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4877
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004878 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4879 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004880
4881
4882source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004883source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004884source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004885 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | no | yes | yes
4888 Arguments :
4889 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4890 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4891 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4892 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4893
4894 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4895 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004896 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4897 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4898 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004899
4900 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4901 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4902 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4903 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4904 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4905 <addr>.
4906
4907 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4908 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4909 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4910 port.
4911
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004912 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4913 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4914 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4915 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4916 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4917 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4918 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4919 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4920 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4921 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4922 HTTP header.
4923
4924 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4925 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004926 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004927 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4928 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4929 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4930 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4931 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4932 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4933 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4934
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004935 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4936 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4937 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4938 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4939 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4940 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4941
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004942 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4943 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4944 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4945 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4946
4947 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4948 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4949 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4950 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4951 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4952 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4953
4954 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4955 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4956 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4957 there are two methods :
4958
4959 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4960 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4961 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4962 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4963 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4964 of the client ranges may be used.
4965
4966 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4967 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4968 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4969 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4970 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4971 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4972 same session.
4973
4974 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4975 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4976 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4977 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4978 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4979 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4980
4981 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4982 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4983 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004984 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004985
4986 Examples :
4987 backend private
4988 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4989 source 192.168.1.200
4990
4991 backend transparent_ssl1
4992 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4993 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4994
4995 backend transparent_ssl2
4996 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4997 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4998 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4999
5000 backend transparent_ssl3
5001 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5002 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5003 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5004
5005 backend transparent_smtp
5006 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5007 # with Tproxy version 4.
5008 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5009
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005010 backend transparent_http
5011 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5012 # proxy.
5013 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005015 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005016 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005018
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005019srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5020 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | no | yes | yes
5023 Arguments :
5024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5026 as explained at the top of this document.
5027
5028 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5029 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5030 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5031 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5032 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5033 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5034 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5035
5036 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5037 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5038 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5039 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5040 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005041 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005042 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005043 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005044
5045 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5046 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5047 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5048 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5049 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5050 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5051
5052 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5053 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5054
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005055 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5056 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005057
5058
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005059stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5060 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 no | no | yes | yes
5063
5064 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5065 matched.
5066
5067 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5068 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5069
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005070 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5071 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5072 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5073
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005074 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5075 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5076 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5077 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005078
5079 Example :
5080 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5081 backend stats_localhost
5082 stats enable
5083 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5084
5085 Example :
5086 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5087 backend stats_auth
5088 stats enable
5089 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5090 stats admin if TRUE
5091
5092 Example :
5093 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5094 userlist stats-auth
5095 group admin users admin
5096 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5097 group readonly users haproxy
5098 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5099
5100 backend stats_auth
5101 stats enable
5102 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5103 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5104 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5105 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5106
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005107 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5108 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5109 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005110
5111
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005112stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5113 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | no | yes | yes
5116 Arguments :
5117 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5118
5119 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5120
5121 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5122 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5123 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5124 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5125 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5126 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5127
5128 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5129 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5130 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005131 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005132
5133 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5134 report using "stats scope".
5135
5136 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5137 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5138 unobvious parameters.
5139
5140 Example :
5141 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5142 backend public_www
5143 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5144 stats enable
5145 stats hide-version
5146 stats scope .
5147 stats uri /admin?stats
5148 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5149 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5150 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5151
5152 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5153 backend private_monitoring
5154 stats enable
5155 stats uri /admin?stats
5156 stats refresh 5s
5157
5158 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5159
5160
5161stats enable
5162 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | yes | yes
5165 Arguments : none
5166
5167 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5168 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5169 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5170 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5171 - stats auth : no authentication
5172 - stats scope : no restriction
5173
5174 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5175 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5176 unobvious parameters.
5177
5178 Example :
5179 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5180 backend public_www
5181 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5182 stats enable
5183 stats hide-version
5184 stats scope .
5185 stats uri /admin?stats
5186 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5187 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5188 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5189
5190 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5191 backend private_monitoring
5192 stats enable
5193 stats uri /admin?stats
5194 stats refresh 5s
5195
5196 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5197
5198
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005199stats hide-version
5200 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5202 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005203 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005204
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005205 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5206 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5207 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5208 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5209 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5210 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005212 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5213 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5214 unobvious parameters.
5215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005216 Example :
5217 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5218 backend public_www
5219 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005220 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005221 stats hide-version
5222 stats scope .
5223 stats uri /admin?stats
5224 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5225 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5226 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005227
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005228 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5229 backend private_monitoring
5230 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005231 stats uri /admin?stats
5232 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005233
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005234 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005235
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005236
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005237stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5238 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5239 Access control for statistics
5240
5241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 no | no | yes | yes
5243
5244 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5245 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5246 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5247 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5248 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5249 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5250
5251 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5252 instance.
5253
5254 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5255 about ACL usage.
5256
5257
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005258stats realm <realm>
5259 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5261 yes | no | yes | yes
5262 Arguments :
5263 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5264 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5265 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5266
5267 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5268 using a backslash ('\').
5269
5270 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5271 only related to authentication.
5272
5273 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5274 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5275 unobvious parameters.
5276
5277 Example :
5278 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5279 backend public_www
5280 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5281 stats enable
5282 stats hide-version
5283 stats scope .
5284 stats uri /admin?stats
5285 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5286 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5287 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5288
5289 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5290 backend private_monitoring
5291 stats enable
5292 stats uri /admin?stats
5293 stats refresh 5s
5294
5295 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5296
5297
5298stats refresh <delay>
5299 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5301 yes | no | yes | yes
5302 Arguments :
5303 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5304 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5305 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5306 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5307 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5308 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5309
5310 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5311 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5312 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5313 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5314
5315 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5316 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5317 unobvious parameters.
5318
5319 Example :
5320 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5321 backend public_www
5322 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5323 stats enable
5324 stats hide-version
5325 stats scope .
5326 stats uri /admin?stats
5327 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5328 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5329 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5330
5331 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5332 backend private_monitoring
5333 stats enable
5334 stats uri /admin?stats
5335 stats refresh 5s
5336
5337 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5338
5339
5340stats scope { <name> | "." }
5341 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 yes | no | yes | yes
5344 Arguments :
5345 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5346 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5347 section in which the statement appears.
5348
5349 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5350 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5351 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5352 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5353 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5354 exists.
5355
5356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5358 unobvious parameters.
5359
5360 Example :
5361 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5362 backend public_www
5363 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5364 stats enable
5365 stats hide-version
5366 stats scope .
5367 stats uri /admin?stats
5368 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5369 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5370 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5371
5372 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5373 backend private_monitoring
5374 stats enable
5375 stats uri /admin?stats
5376 stats refresh 5s
5377
5378 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5379
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005380
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005381stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005382 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 yes | no | yes | yes
5385
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005386 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005387 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5388
5389 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5390 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5391
5392 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5393 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005394 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005395
5396 Example :
5397 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5398 backend private_monitoring
5399 stats enable
5400 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5401 stats uri /admin?stats
5402 stats refresh 5s
5403
5404 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5405 global section.
5406
5407
5408stats show-legends
5409 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5410 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5411 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5412 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5413 - IP (socket, server)
5414 - cookie (backend, server)
5415
5416 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5417 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005418 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005419
5420 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5421
5422
5423stats show-node [ <name> ]
5424 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | no | yes | yes
5427 Arguments:
5428 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5429 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5430
5431 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5432 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005433 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005434
5435 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5436 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5437 unobvious parameters.
5438
5439 Example:
5440 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5441 backend private_monitoring
5442 stats enable
5443 stats show-node Europe-1
5444 stats uri /admin?stats
5445 stats refresh 5s
5446
5447 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5448 section.
5449
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005450
5451stats uri <prefix>
5452 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5454 yes | no | yes | yes
5455 Arguments :
5456 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5457 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5458 query string.
5459
5460 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5461 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5462 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5463 possible to reach it in the application.
5464
5465 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005466 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005467 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5468 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5469 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5470 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5471
5472 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5473 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5474 an address or a port to statistics only.
5475
5476 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5477 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5478 unobvious parameters.
5479
5480 Example :
5481 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5482 backend public_www
5483 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5484 stats enable
5485 stats hide-version
5486 stats scope .
5487 stats uri /admin?stats
5488 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5489 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5490 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5491
5492 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5493 backend private_monitoring
5494 stats enable
5495 stats uri /admin?stats
5496 stats refresh 5s
5497
5498 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5499
5500
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005501stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5502 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005504 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005505
5506 Arguments :
5507 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5508 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5509 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5510 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5511
5512 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5513 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5514 the "stick-table" statement.
5515
5516 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5517 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5518 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5519 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5520 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5521
5522 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5523 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5524 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5525 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5526 transformation rules.
5527
5528 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5529 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5530 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5531 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5532 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5533 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5534 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5535
5536 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5537 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5538 ACL based conditions.
5539
5540 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5541 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5542 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5543 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5544
5545 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5546 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5547 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5548 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5549
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005550 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5551 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5552 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5553
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005554 Example :
5555 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5556 # last 30 minutes
5557 backend pop
5558 mode tcp
5559 balance roundrobin
5560 stick store-request src
5561 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5562 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5563 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5564
5565 backend smtp
5566 mode tcp
5567 balance roundrobin
5568 stick match src table pop
5569 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5570 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5571
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005572 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5573 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005574
5575
5576stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5577 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5579 no | no | yes | yes
5580
5581 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5582 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5583 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5584 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5585
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005586 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5587 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5588 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5589
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005590 Examples :
5591 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005592 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005593
5594 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5595 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5596 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5597
5598
5599 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5600 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5601 backend http
5602 mode http
5603 balance roundrobin
5604 stick on src table https
5605 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5606 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5607 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5608
5609 backend https
5610 mode tcp
5611 balance roundrobin
5612 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5613 stick on src
5614 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5615 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5616
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005617 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005618
5619
5620stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5621 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5623 no | no | yes | yes
5624
5625 Arguments :
5626 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5627 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5628 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5629 server is selected.
5630
5631 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5632 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5633 the "stick-table" statement.
5634
5635 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5636 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5637 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5638 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5639 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5640 address.
5641
5642 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5643 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5644 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5645 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5646 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5647 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5648 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5649 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5650 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5651 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5652
5653 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5654 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5655 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5656 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5657 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5658 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5659 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5660
5661 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5662 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5663 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5664 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5665
5666 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5667 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5668 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5669 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5670 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5671 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5672 another protocol or access method.
5673
5674 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5675 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5676 the request.
5677
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005678 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5679 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5680 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5681
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005682 Example :
5683 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5684 # last 30 minutes
5685 backend pop
5686 mode tcp
5687 balance roundrobin
5688 stick store-request src
5689 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5690 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5691 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5692
5693 backend smtp
5694 mode tcp
5695 balance roundrobin
5696 stick match src table pop
5697 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5698 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5699
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005700 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5701 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005702
5703
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005704stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005705 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5706 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005707 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005709 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005710
5711 Arguments :
5712 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5713 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5714 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5715 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5716
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005717 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5718 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5719 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5720 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5721
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005722 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5723 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5724 instance.
5725
5726 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5727 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5728 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5729 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5730 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5731 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005732 to 32 characters.
5733
5734 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5735 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5736 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5737 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5738 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5739 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005740
5741 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005742 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5743 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005744 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5745 increase.
5746
5747 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005748 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5749 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5750 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005751
5752 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5753 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5754 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5755 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5756 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5757 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5758 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5759 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5760 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5761 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5762 parameter (see below).
5763
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005764 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5765 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5766 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5767 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5768 soft restart.
5769
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005770 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5771
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005772 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5773 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5774 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5775 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5776 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005777 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005778 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5779 if not expiration delay is specified.
5780
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005781 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5782 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5783 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5784 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005785 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5786 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5787 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5788 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5789 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5790 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5791 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5792 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5793 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5794 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5795 types and their arguments.
5796
5797 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5798 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5799 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5800 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5801
5802 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5803 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5804 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5805 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5806
5807 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5808 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5809 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5810 they were received.
5811
5812 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5813 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5814 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5815 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5816 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5817
5818 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5819 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5820 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5821 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5822 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5823
5824 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5825 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5826 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5827
5828 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5829 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5830 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5831 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5832 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5833
5834 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5835 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5836 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5837 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5838 the client side.
5839
5840 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5841 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5842 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5843 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5844 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5845 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5846 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5847
5848 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5849 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5850 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5851 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5852 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5853 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5854 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5855
5856 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5857 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5858 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5859 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5860 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5861 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5862
5863 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5864 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5865 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5866 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5867
5868 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5869 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5870 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5871 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5872 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5873 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5874 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5875 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5876 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5877 recommended for better fairness.
5878
5879 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5880 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5881 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5882 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5883
5884 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5885 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5886 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5887 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5888 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5889 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5890 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5891 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5892 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5893 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005894
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005895 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5896 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005897 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5898 reference it.
5899
5900 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5901 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5902 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5903 as an exclusive stickiness.
5904
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005905 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5906 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5907 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5908 something that can be ignored.
5909
5910 Example:
5911 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5912 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5913 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5914 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5915
5916 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005917 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005918
5919
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005920stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5921 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5923 no | no | yes | yes
5924
5925 Arguments :
5926 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5927 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5928 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5929 server is selected.
5930
5931 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5932 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5933 the "stick-table" statement.
5934
5935 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5936 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5937 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5938 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5939
5940 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5941 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5942 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5943 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5944 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5945 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005946 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005947 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5948 rules.
5949
5950 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5951 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5952 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5953 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5954 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5955 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5956 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5957
5958 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5959 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5960 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5961 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5962
5963 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5964 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5965 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5966 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5967 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5968 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5969 another protocol or access method.
5970
5971 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5972
5973 Example :
5974 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5975 backend https
5976 mode tcp
5977 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005978 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005979 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005980
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005981 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5982 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5983
5984 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5985 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5986 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5987
5988 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5989 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005990
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005991 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5992 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5993 # at offset 44.
5994
5995 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5996 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5997
5998 # Learn on response if server hello.
5999 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006000
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006001 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6002 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6003
6004 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6005 extraction.
6006
6007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006008tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6009 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6011 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006012 Arguments :
6013 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6014 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6015 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006017 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006018
6019 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6020 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006021 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6022 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6023 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6024 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6025 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6026 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6029 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6030 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6031 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006033 Three types of actions are supported :
6034 - accept :
6035 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6036 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6037 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006039 - reject :
6040 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6041 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6042 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6043 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6044 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6045 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6046 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6047 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6048 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6049 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6050 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6051 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006053 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6054 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6055 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6056 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6057 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6058 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6059 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6060 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6061 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006063 These actions take one or two arguments :
6064 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6065 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6066 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006068 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6069 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6070 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6071 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006073 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6074 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6075 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6076 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6077 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6078 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6079 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6080 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6081 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6082 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006084 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6085 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6086 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6089 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6090 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006092 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006093 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006094 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006096 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6097 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6098 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006100 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6101 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6102 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006103
6104 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006106 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006107
6108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6110 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006112 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006113 Arguments :
6114 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6115 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6116 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006120 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6121 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6122 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6123 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6124 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006126 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6127 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6128 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6129 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6130 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6131 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6132 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6133 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6134 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006136 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6137 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6138 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6139 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006141 Three types of actions are supported :
6142 - accept :
6143 - reject :
6144 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006146 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6147 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006149 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6150 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6151 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6152 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6153 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6154 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006156 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006157 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6158 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006159
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006160 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006161 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6162 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6163 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6164 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6165 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006166
6167 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006168 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6169 # and reject everything else.
6170 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6171 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006172 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006173 tcp-request content reject
6174
6175 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006176 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6177 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6178 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006179 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006180
6181 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6182 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6183 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006184 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006185 tcp-request content reject
6186
6187 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6188 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6189
6190 frontend http
6191 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6192 # protecting all our sites
6193 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6194 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6195 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6196 ...
6197 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6198
6199 backend http_dynamic
6200 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6201 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6202 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6203 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6204 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6205 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6206 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006208 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006209
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006210 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006211
6212
6213tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6214 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006216 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006217 Arguments :
6218 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6219 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6220 as explained at the top of this document.
6221
6222 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6223 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6224 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6225 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6226 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6227
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006228 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6229 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6230 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6231 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6232
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006233 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6234 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006235 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006236 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006237 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6238 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6239 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6240 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006241
6242 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6243 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6244 it pass through unaffected.
6245
6246 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6247 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6248 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006249 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006250 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6251 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006252 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6253 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6254 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006255
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006256 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006257 "timeout client".
6258
6259
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006260tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6261 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6263 no | no | yes | yes
6264 Arguments :
6265 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6266 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6267 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6268
6269 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6270
6271 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6272 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6273 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6274 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006275 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006276
6277 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6278
6279 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6280 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6281 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6282 inserted.
6283
6284 Two types of actions are supported :
6285 - accept :
6286 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6287 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6288 the rules evaluation.
6289
6290 - reject :
6291 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6292 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006293 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006294
6295 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6296 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6297 for changing the default action to a reject.
6298
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006299 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6300 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6301 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6302 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006303 period.
6304
6305 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6306
6307 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6308
6309
6310tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6311 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6313 no | no | yes | yes
6314 Arguments :
6315 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6316 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6317 as explained at the top of this document.
6318
6319 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6320
6321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006322timeout check <timeout>
6323 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6324 established.
6325
6326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6327 yes | no | yes | yes
6328 Arguments:
6329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6331 as explained at the top of this document.
6332
6333 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6334 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6335 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6336 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006337 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6338 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6339 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006340
6341 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6342 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6343
6344 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6345 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006346 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006347
6348 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6349 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6350 forget about it.
6351
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006352 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6353 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006354
6355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006356timeout client <timeout>
6357timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6358 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | no
6361 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006362 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006363 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6364 as explained at the top of this document.
6365
6366 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6367 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6368 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6369 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6370 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6371 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6372 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6373 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006374 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006375 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006376 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6377 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6378 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006379
6380 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6381 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6382 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6383 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6384 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6385 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6386
6387 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6388 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6389 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6390
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006391 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006392
6393
6394timeout connect <timeout>
6395timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6396 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6398 yes | no | yes | yes
6399 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006400 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006401 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6402 as explained at the top of this document.
6403
6404 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006405 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006406 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006407 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006408 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6409 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006410
6411 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6412 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6413 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6414 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6415 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6416 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6417
6418 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6419 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6420 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6421
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006422 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6423 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006424
6425
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006426timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6427 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6429 yes | yes | yes | yes
6430 Arguments :
6431 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6432 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6433 as explained at the top of this document.
6434
6435 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6436 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6437 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6438 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6439 once the request has started to present itself.
6440
6441 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6442 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6443 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6444 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6445 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6446
6447 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6448 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6449 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6450 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6451
6452 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6453 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6454 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6455 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6456 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006457 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006458
6459 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6460 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6461 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6462 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6463
6464 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6465
6466
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006467timeout http-request <timeout>
6468 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006470 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006471 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006472 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006473 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6474 as explained at the top of this document.
6475
6476 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6477 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6478 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6479 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6480 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6481 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6482 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6483 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6484
6485 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6486 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006487 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6488 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006489
6490 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6491 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6492 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6493 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6494 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6495
6496 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006497 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6498 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6499 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006500
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006501 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006502
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006503
6504timeout queue <timeout>
6505 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | no | yes | yes
6508 Arguments :
6509 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6511 as explained at the top of this document.
6512
6513 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6514 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6515 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6516 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6517 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6518
6519 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6520 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6521 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6522 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6523
6524 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6525
6526
6527timeout server <timeout>
6528timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6529 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 yes | no | yes | yes
6532 Arguments :
6533 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6534 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6535 as explained at the top of this document.
6536
6537 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6538 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6539 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6540 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6541 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6542 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6543 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6544
6545 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6546 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6547 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6548 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6549 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006550 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006551 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006552 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6553 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6554 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6555 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006556
6557 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6558 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6559 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6560 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6561 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6562 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6563
6564 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6565 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6566 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6567
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006568 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006569
6570
6571timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006572 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | yes | yes | yes
6575 Arguments :
6576 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6577 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6578 as explained at the top of this document.
6579
6580 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6581 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6582 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6583
6584 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6585 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6586 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6587 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006588 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006589
6590 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6591
6592
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006593timeout tunnel <timeout>
6594 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6596 yes | no | yes | yes
6597 Arguments :
6598 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6599 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6600 as explained at the top of this document.
6601
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006602 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006603 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6604 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6605 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6606 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6607 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6608 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6609 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6610 specified.
6611
6612 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6613 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6614 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6615 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6616 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6617
6618 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6619 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6620 forget about it.
6621
6622 Example :
6623 defaults http
6624 option http-server-close
6625 timeout connect 5s
6626 timeout client 30s
6627 timeout client 30s
6628 timeout server 30s
6629 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6630
6631 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6632
6633
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006634transparent (deprecated)
6635 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006637 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006638 Arguments : none
6639
6640 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6641 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6642 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6643 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6644 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6645 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6646 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6647 appropriate server.
6648
6649 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6650
6651 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6652 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6653
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006654 See also: "option transparent"
6655
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006656unique-id-format <string>
6657 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6659 yes | yes | yes | no
6660 Arguments :
6661 <string> is a log-format string.
6662
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006663 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6664 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6665 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6666 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006667
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006668 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6669 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6670 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6671 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6672 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6673 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6674 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6675 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006677 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6678 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006679
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006680 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006681
6682 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6683
6684 will generate:
6685
6686 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6687
6688 See also: "unique-id-header"
6689
6690unique-id-header <name>
6691 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 yes | yes | yes | no
6694 Arguments :
6695 <name> is the name of the header.
6696
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006697 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6698 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006699
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006700 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006701
6702 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6703 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6704
6705 will generate:
6706
6707 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6708
6709 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006710
6711use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6712use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006713 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6715 no | yes | yes | no
6716 Arguments :
6717 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006719 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006720
6721 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6722 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6723 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006724 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6725 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6726 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6727 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006728
6729 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6730 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6731 assign the backend.
6732
6733 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6734 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6735 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6736 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6737 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6738 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6739
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006740 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006741 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006742 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6743 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6744 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6745
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006746 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006747
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006748
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006749use-server <server> if <condition>
6750use-server <server> unless <condition>
6751 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6753 no | no | yes | yes
6754 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006755 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006756
6757 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6758
6759 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6760 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6761 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6762
6763 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6764 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6765 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6766 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6767 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6768 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6769 matches will assign the server.
6770
6771 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6772 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6773 with the next rules until one matches.
6774
6775 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6776 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6777 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6778 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6779
6780 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6781 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6782 stripped.
6783
6784 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6785 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6786 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6787 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6788
6789 Example :
6790 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6791 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6792 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6793 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6794 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6795 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6796 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6797 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6798 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6799
6800 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6801
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006802
68035. Bind and Server options
6804--------------------------
6805
6806The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6807depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6808settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6809written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6810described in this section.
6811
6812
68135.1. Bind options
6814-----------------
6815
6816The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6817as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6818no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6819parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6820while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6821provided immediately after the setting name.
6822
6823The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6824
6825accept-proxy
6826 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6827 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6828 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6829 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6830 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6831 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6832 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6833 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6834 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6835 usable.
6836
6837backlog <backlog>
6838 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6839 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6840
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006841ecdhe <named curve>
6842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6843 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6844 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6845
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006846ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6848 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6849 client's certificate.
6850
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006851ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6853 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6854 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6855 error is ignored.
6856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006857ciphers <ciphers>
6858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6859 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6860 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6861 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6862 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6863
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006864crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6866 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6867 to verify client's certificate.
6868
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006869crt <cert>
6870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6871 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6872 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006873 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6874 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6875 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6876 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6877 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6878 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6879 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6880 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006881 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006882 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6883 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6884 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6885 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6886 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006887
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006888crt-ignore-err <errors>
6889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6890 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6891 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6892 error is ignored.
6893
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006894defer-accept
6895 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6896 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6897 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6898 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6899 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6900 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6901 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6902 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6903 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6904 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6905 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6906
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006907force-sslv3
6908 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6909 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6910 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6911
6912force-tlsv10
6913 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6914 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6915
6916force-tlsv11
6917 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6918 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6919
6920force-tlsv12
6921 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6922 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6923
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006924gid <gid>
6925 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6926 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6927 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6928 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6929 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6930
6931group <group>
6932 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6933 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6934 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6935 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6936 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6937
6938id <id>
6939 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6940 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6941 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6942 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6943
6944interface <interface>
6945 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6946 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6947 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6948 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6949 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6950 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6951 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6952 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6953
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006954level <level>
6955 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6956 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6957 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6958 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6959 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6960 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6961 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6962 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6963 counters).
6964 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6965 all counters).
6966
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006967maxconn <maxconn>
6968 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6969 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6970 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6971 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6972 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6973 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6974 eat all memory.
6975
6976mode <mode>
6977 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6978 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6979 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6980 UNIX sockets.
6981
6982mss <maxseg>
6983 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6984 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6985 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6986 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6987 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6988 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6989 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6990 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6991 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6992 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6993 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6994
6995name <name>
6996 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6997 page.
6998
6999nice <nice>
7000 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7001 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7002 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7003 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7004 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7005 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7006 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7007 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7008 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7009 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7010 one for an RDP socket.
7011
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007012no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7014 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7015 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007016 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7017 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007018
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007019no-tls-tickets
7020 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7021 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7022 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7023 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7024
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007025no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007027 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7028 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7029 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7030 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007031
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007032no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007034 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7035 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7036 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7037 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007038
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007039no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007041 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7042 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7043 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7044 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007045
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007046npn <protocols>
7047 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7048 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7049 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7050 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7051 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7052
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007053ssl
7054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7055 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7056 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7057 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7058 to deciphered contents.
7059
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007060tfo
7061 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7062 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7063 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7064 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7065 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7066 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7067 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7068 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7069 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7070
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007071transparent
7072 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7073 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7074 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7075 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7076 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7077 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7078 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7079 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7080 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7081 so check for support with your vendor.
7082
7083uid <uid>
7084 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7085 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7086 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7087 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7088 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7089
7090user <user>
7091 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7092 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7093 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7094 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7095 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7096
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007097verify [none|optional|required]
7098 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7099 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7100 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7101 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7102 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007103 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7104 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7105 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7106 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020071085.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007109------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007111The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7112which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7113arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7114settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7115after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7116Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7117address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007119 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007120 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007122The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007123
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007124addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007125 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7126 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7127 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7128 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7129 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007130
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007131 Supported in default-server: No
7132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007133backup
7134 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7135 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7136 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7137 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7138 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7139 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007140
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007141 Supported in default-server: No
7142
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007143ca-file <cafile>
7144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7145 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7146 server's certificate.
7147
7148 Supported in default-server: No
7149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007150check
7151 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007152 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7153 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7154 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7155 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7156 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7157 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7158 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7159 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7160 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7161 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007163 Supported in default-server: No
7164
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007165check-send-proxy
7166 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7167 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7168 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7169 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7170 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7171 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7172 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7173
7174 Supported in default-server: No
7175
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007176check-ssl
7177 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7178 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7179 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7180 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7181 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7182 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7183 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7184 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7185 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7186
7187 Supported in default-server: No
7188
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007189ciphers <ciphers>
7190 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7191 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7192 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7193 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7194 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7195 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7196 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7197 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7198
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007199 Supported in default-server: No
7200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007201cookie <value>
7202 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7203 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7204 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7205 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7206 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7207 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7208 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007210 Supported in default-server: No
7211
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007212crl-file <crlfile>
7213 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7214 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7215 to verify server's certificate.
7216
7217 Supported in default-server: No
7218
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007219crt <cert>
7220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7221 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7222 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7223 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7224 certificate request.
7225
7226 Supported in default-server: No
7227
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007228disabled
7229 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7230 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7231 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7232 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7233 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7234
7235 Supported in default-server: No
7236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007237error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007238 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7239 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7240 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007242 Supported in default-server: Yes
7243
7244 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007246fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007247 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7248 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7249 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007251 Supported in default-server: Yes
7252
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007253force-sslv3
7254 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7255 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7256 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7257
7258 Supported in default-server: No
7259
7260force-tlsv10
7261 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7262 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7263
7264 Supported in default-server: No
7265
7266force-tlsv11
7267 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7268 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7269
7270 Supported in default-server: No
7271
7272force-tlsv12
7273 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7274 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7275
7276 Supported in default-server: No
7277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007278id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007279 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7280 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7281 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007283 Supported in default-server: No
7284
7285inter <delay>
7286fastinter <delay>
7287downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007288 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7289 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7290 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7291 between checks depending on the server state :
7292
7293 Server state | Interval used
7294 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7295 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7296 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7297 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7298 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7299 or yet unchecked. |
7300 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7301 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7302 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007304 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7305 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7306 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7307 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7308 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7309 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7310 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7311 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7312 servers.
7313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007314 Supported in default-server: Yes
7315
7316maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007317 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7318 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7319 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7320 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7321 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7322 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7323 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7324 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007326 Supported in default-server: Yes
7327
7328maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007329 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7330 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7331 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7332 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7333 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7334 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7335 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007337 Supported in default-server: Yes
7338
7339minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007340 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7341 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7342 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7343 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7344 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7345 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007346 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007347 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007349 Supported in default-server: Yes
7350
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007351no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007352 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7353 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007354 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007355
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007356 Supported in default-server: No
7357
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007358no-tls-tickets
7359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7360 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7361 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7362 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7363
7364 Supported in default-server: No
7365
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007366no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007367 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007368 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7369 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007370 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7371 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007372
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007373 Supported in default-server: No
7374
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007375no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007376 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007377 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7378 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007379 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7380 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007381
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007382 Supported in default-server: No
7383
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007384no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007385 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007386 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7387 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007388 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7389 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007390
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007391 Supported in default-server: No
7392
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007393non-stick
7394 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7395 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7396 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7397
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007398 Supported in default-server: No
7399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007400observe <mode>
7401 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7402 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7403 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7404 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7405 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7406 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007407 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007409 Supported in default-server: No
7410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007411 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007413on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007414 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7415 Currently, four modes are available:
7416 - fastinter: force fastinter
7417 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7418 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7419 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7420 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007422 Supported in default-server: Yes
7423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007424 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7425
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007426on-marked-down <action>
7427 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7428 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007429 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7430 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7431 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7432 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7433 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7434 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7435 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7436 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007437
7438 Actions are disabled by default
7439
7440 Supported in default-server: Yes
7441
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007442on-marked-up <action>
7443 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7444 Currently one action is available:
7445 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7446 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7447 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7448 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7449 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7450 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7451 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7452 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7453
7454 Actions are disabled by default
7455
7456 Supported in default-server: Yes
7457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007458port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007459 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7460 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7461 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7462 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7463 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7464 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007466 Supported in default-server: Yes
7467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007468redir <prefix>
7469 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7470 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7471 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7472 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7473 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7474 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7475 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7476 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007477 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007478 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7479 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7480 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7481 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7482 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7483
7484 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007486 Supported in default-server: No
7487
7488rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007489 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7490 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7491 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7492
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007493 Supported in default-server: Yes
7494
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007495send-proxy
7496 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7497 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7498 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7499 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7500 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7501 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7502 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7503 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7504 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007505 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7506 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7507 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7508 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7509 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007510
7511 Supported in default-server: No
7512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007513slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007514 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7515 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7516 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7517 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7518 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7519 parameters :
7520
7521 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7522 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7523
7524 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7525 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7526 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7527 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7528
7529 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7530 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7531 seen as failed.
7532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007533 Supported in default-server: Yes
7534
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007535source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007536source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007537source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007538 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7539 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7540 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7541 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7542
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007543 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7544 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7545 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7546 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7547 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7548 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7549 server.
7550
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007551 Supported in default-server: No
7552
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007553ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007554 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7555 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7556 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7557 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7558 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7559 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7560 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7561 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7562
7563 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007565track [<proxy>/]<server>
7566 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7567 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7568 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7569 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7570 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007572 Supported in default-server: No
7573
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007574verify [none|required]
7575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7576 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7577 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7578 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7579 is aborted.
7580
7581 Supported in default-server: No
7582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007583weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007584 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7585 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7586 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007587 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7588 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7589 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7590 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7591 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7592 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007594 Supported in default-server: Yes
7595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007596
75976. HTTP header manipulation
7598---------------------------
7599
7600In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7601response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7602request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7603which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7604against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7605to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7606passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7607headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7608never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7609
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007610There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7611(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7612rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7613messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7614in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007615happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007616add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7617normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007619This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7620in section 4.2 :
7621
7622 - reqadd <string>
7623 - reqallow <search>
7624 - reqiallow <search>
7625 - reqdel <search>
7626 - reqidel <search>
7627 - reqdeny <search>
7628 - reqideny <search>
7629 - reqpass <search>
7630 - reqipass <search>
7631 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7632 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7633 - reqtarpit <search>
7634 - reqitarpit <search>
7635 - rspadd <string>
7636 - rspdel <search>
7637 - rspidel <search>
7638 - rspdeny <search>
7639 - rspideny <search>
7640 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7641 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7642
7643With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7644is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7645parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7646prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7647Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7648
7649 \t for a tab
7650 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7651 \n for a new line (LF)
7652 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7653 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7654 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7655 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7656 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7657
7658The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7659portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7660above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7661regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
76629 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7663is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7664
7665The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7666after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7667
7668Notes related to these keywords :
7669---------------------------------
7670 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7671 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7672 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7673
7674 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7675 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7676 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7677
7678 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7679 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7680 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7681 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7682 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7683
7684 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7685 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7686 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7687 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7688 useless headers before adding new ones.
7689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007690 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007691 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7692
7693 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7694 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7695 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7696
7697 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7698 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007699 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007700
7701
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077027. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7703------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007704
7705The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7706content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7707from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7708simple :
7709
7710 - define test criteria with sets of values
7711 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7712
7713The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7714
7715In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7716
7717 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7718
7719This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7720Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7721and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7722an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7723of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7724
7725ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7726'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7727which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7728
7729There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7730performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7731
7732The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7733
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007734 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7735 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007736 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7737
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007738The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7739specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7740possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007741multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7742be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7743needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7744space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7745match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7746lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7747duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007748to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007749instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007750
7751 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7752
7753In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7754the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7755case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7756too.
7757
7758Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7759a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7760ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007762Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007764 - integers or integer ranges
7765 - strings
7766 - regular expressions
7767 - IP addresses and networks
7768
7769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077707.1. Matching integers
7771----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007772
7773Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7774that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7775expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7776may be omitted.
7777
7778For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7779unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7780representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7781
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007782As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7783two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7784instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7785ranges and operators.
7786
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007787For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007788operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7789Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7790of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007792Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007793
7794 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7795 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7796 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7797 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7798 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007800For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007801
7802 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7803
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007804This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7805
7806 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078097.2. Matching strings
7810---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007811
7812String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7813exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7814characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7815string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7816to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007817before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007818
7819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078207.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7821-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007822
7823Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7824they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7825possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7826passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7827the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007828the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7829match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007830
7831
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020078327.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007833----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007834
7835IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7836netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7837within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007838host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007839difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7840at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7841does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7842parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007843
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007844IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7845Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7846trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7847IPv6 patterns.
7848
7849HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7850following situations :
7851 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7852 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7853 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7854 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7855 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7856 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7857 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7858 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7859 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7860 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7861
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078637.5. Available matching criteria
7864--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7867------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007868
7869A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7870analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007871addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007872
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007873always_false
7874 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7875 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7876
7877always_true
7878 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7879 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7880
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007881avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007882avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007883 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7884 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7885 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7886 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7887 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7888 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7889 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7890 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7891 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7892 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7893 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007894
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007895be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007896be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007897 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7898 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7899 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7900 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7901 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007902
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007903be_id <integer>
7904 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7905 backend it was called.
7906
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007907be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007908be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007909 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7910 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7911 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7912 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7913 sucking of an online dictionary).
7914
7915 Example :
7916 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7917 backend dynamic
7918 mode http
7919 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7920 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007921
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007922connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007923connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007924 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007925 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007926 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7927
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007928 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7929 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007930
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007931 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007932 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7933 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7934 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7935 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7936 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007937 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007938
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007939 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7940 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7941 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7942 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007944dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007945 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7946 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007947
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007948dst_conn <integer>
7949 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7950 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7951 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7952 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7953 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7954 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7955
7956dst_port <integer>
7957 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7958 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7959
7960fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007961fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007962 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7963 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7964 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7965 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7966 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7967 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7968 criteria.
7969
7970fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007971 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007972 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007973
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007974fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007975fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007976 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7977 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7978 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7979 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7980 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7981 the rate to go down below the limit.
7982
7983 Example :
7984 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7985 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7986 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7987 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7988 frontend mail
7989 bind :25
7990 mode tcp
7991 maxconn 100
7992 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7993 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7994 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7995 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007996
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007997nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007998nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007999 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8000 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8001 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8002 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8003 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008004
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008005queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008006queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008007 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8008 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8009 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8010 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8011 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8012 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8013 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008015sc1_bytes_in_rate
8016sc2_bytes_in_rate
8017 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8018 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8019 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8020
8021sc1_bytes_out_rate
8022sc2_bytes_out_rate
8023 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8024 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8025 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8026
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008027sc1_clr_gpc0
8028sc2_clr_gpc0
8029 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8030 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8031 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8032 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8033 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8034 was verified :
8035
8036 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8037 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8038 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8039 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8040 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8041 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8042 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008044sc1_conn_cnt
8045sc2_conn_cnt
8046 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8047 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8048
8049sc1_conn_cur
8050sc2_conn_cur
8051 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8052 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8053 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8054
8055sc1_conn_rate
8056sc2_conn_rate
8057 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8058 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8059 See also src_conn_rate.
8060
8061sc1_get_gpc0
8062sc2_get_gpc0
8063 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8064 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8065
8066sc1_http_err_cnt
8067sc2_http_err_cnt
8068 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8069 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8070 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8071
8072sc1_http_err_rate
8073sc2_http_err_rate
8074 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8075 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8076 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8077 src_http_err_rate.
8078
8079sc1_http_req_cnt
8080sc2_http_req_cnt
8081 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8082 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8083 src_http_req_cnt.
8084
8085sc1_http_req_rate
8086sc2_http_req_rate
8087 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8088 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8089 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8090 src_http_req_rate.
8091
8092sc1_inc_gpc0
8093sc2_inc_gpc0
8094 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8095 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8096 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8097 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8098 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8099 when a first ACL was verified :
8100
8101 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8102 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8103 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8104
8105sc1_kbytes_in
8106sc2_kbytes_in
8107 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8108 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8109 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8110 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8111
8112sc1_kbytes_out
8113sc2_kbytes_out
8114 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8115 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8116 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8117 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8118
8119sc1_sess_cnt
8120sc2_sess_cnt
8121 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8122 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8123 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8124 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008125 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008126 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8127
8128sc1_sess_rate
8129sc2_sess_rate
8130 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8131 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8132 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8133 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8134 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008135 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008136
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008137so_id <integer>
8138 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8139
8140src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008141 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8142 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8143 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008144
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008145src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008146src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008147 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8148 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8149 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008150 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008151
8152src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008153src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008154 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8155 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8156 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008157 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008158
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008159src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8160src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8161 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8162 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8163 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8164 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8165 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8166 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8167
8168 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8169 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8170 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8171 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8172 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8173 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8174 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8175
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008176src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008177src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008178 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8179 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8180 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008181 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008182
8183src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008184src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008185 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8186 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8187 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008188 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008189
8190src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008191src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008192 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8193 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8194 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008195 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008196
8197src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008198src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008199 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8200 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8201 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008202 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008203
8204src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008205src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008206 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8207 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8208 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008209 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008210
8211src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008212src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008213 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8214 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8215 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8216 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008217 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008218
8219src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008220src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008221 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8222 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8223 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008224 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008225
8226src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008227src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008228 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8229 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8230 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8231 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008232 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008233
8234src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008235src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008236 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8237 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8238 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8239 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8240 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8241 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8242
8243 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8244 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008245 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008246
8247src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008248src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008249 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8250 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8251 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8252 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008253 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008254
8255src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008256src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008257 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8258 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8259 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8260 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008261 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008262
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008263src_port <integer>
8264 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008265
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008266src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008267src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008268 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8269 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8270 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8271 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008272 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008273
8274src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008275src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008276 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8277 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8278 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8279 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008280 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008281
8282src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008283src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008284 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008285 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8286 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008287 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8288 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8289 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008290 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008291
8292 Example :
8293 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8294 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8295 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8296 listen ssh
8297 bind :22
8298 mode tcp
8299 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008300 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008301 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8302 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8303
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008304srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008305 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8306 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8307 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8308 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8309
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008310srv_id <integer>
8311 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8312
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008313srv_is_up(<server>)
8314srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8315 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8316 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8317 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8318 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8319 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8320 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8321 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8322 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8323
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008324table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008325table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008326 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8327 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8328
8329table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008330table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008331 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8332 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8333 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8334
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008335
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020083367.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8337---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008338
8339A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8340during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008341through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8342keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008343
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008344rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8345 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8346 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8347 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008348 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8349 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8350 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008351
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008352req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008353 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008354 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8355 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8356 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8357 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8358 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8359 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8360
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008361req_proto_http
8362 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8363 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008364 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008365 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8366 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8367
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008368req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008369req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008370 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8371 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8372 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8373 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8374 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8375 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8376 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8377 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8378
8379req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008380req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008381 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8382 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8383 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8384 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8385 cookies.
8386
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008387req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8388 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8389 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8390 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008391 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8392 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8393 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008394
8395req_ssl_sni <string>
8396 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8397 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8398 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8399 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8400 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8401 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8402 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008403 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8404 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008405 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008406 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008407
8408 Examples :
8409 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8410 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8411 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8412 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8413 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8414
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008415req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8416 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8417 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8418 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8419 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8420 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8421 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008422 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8423 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008424 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008425 option.
8426
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008427ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8428 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8429 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8430 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8431 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8432 during this verification process.
8433
8434ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8435 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8436 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8437 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8438 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8439
8440ssl_c_err <integer>
8441 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8442 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8443 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8444 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8445
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008446ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8447ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8448 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8449 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8450 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8451 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8452 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8453 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8454 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8455 DN matches the specified string.
8456
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008457ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8458 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8459 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8460 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8461
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008462ssl_c_notafter <string>
8463 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8464 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8465 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8466
8467ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8468 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8469 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8470 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8471
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008472ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8473ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8474 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8475 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8476 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8477 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8478 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8479 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8480 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8481 DN matches the specified string.
8482
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008483ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8484 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8485 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8486 the value written in hexa.
8487
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008488ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8489 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8490 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8491 by the client matches the string.
8492
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008493ssl_c_verify <integer>
8494 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8495 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8496 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8497
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008498ssl_c_version <integer>
8499 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8500 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8501 the value.
8502
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008503ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8504ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8505 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8506 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8507 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8508 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8509 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8510 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8511 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8512 DN matches the specified string.
8513
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008514ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8515 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8516 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8517 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8518
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008519ssl_f_notafter <string>
8520 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8521 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8522 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8523
8524ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8525 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8526 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8527 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8528
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008529ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8530ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8531 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8532 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8533 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8534 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8535 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8536 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8537 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8538 DN matches the specified string.
8539
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008540ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8541 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8542 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8543 the value written in hexa.
8544
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008545ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8546 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8547 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8548 by the frontend matches the string.
8549
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008550ssl_f_version <integer>
8551 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8552 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8553 the value.
8554
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008555ssl_fc
8556 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8557 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8558 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8559
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008560ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8561 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8562 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8563
8564ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8565 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8566 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8567
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008568ssl_fc_has_crt
8569 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8570 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8571
8572ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008573 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008574 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8575 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8576 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8577 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008578
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008579ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008580 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8581 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8582 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8583 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008584 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8585 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8586 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008587
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008588ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8589 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8590 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8591
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008592ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008593 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8594 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8595 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8596 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008597 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8598 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008599 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8600 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8601 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008602
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008603ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008604 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8605 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8606 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8607 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008608 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8609 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8610 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8611 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008612
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008613ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008614 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8615 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8616 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8617 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008618 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8619 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8620 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8621 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008622
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008623ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8624 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8625 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8626
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008627wait_end
8628 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8629 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8630 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8631 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8632 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8633 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8634 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8635 inspection.
8636
8637 Examples :
8638 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8639 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8640 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8641
8642 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8643 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8644 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8645 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8646 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8647 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8648 tcp-request content reject
8649
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086517.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8652--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008653
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008654A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008655application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8656read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8657than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8658
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008659base <string>
8660 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8661 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8662 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8663 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8664 See also "path" and "uri".
8665
8666base_beg <string>
8667 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8668 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8669 "path_beg".
8670
8671base_dir <string>
8672 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8673 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8674 "path_dir" instead.
8675
8676base_dom <string>
8677 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8678 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8679 instead.
8680
8681base_end <string>
8682 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8683 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8684
8685base_len <integer>
8686 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8687 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8688
8689base_reg <regex>
8690 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8691 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8692 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8693 and all "base_" criteria.
8694
8695base_sub <string>
8696 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8697 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8698 also "base_dir".
8699
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008700cook(<name>) <string>
8701 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8702 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8703 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8704 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8705 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8706 sent by the server.
8707
8708 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8709 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8710 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8711
8712 cook(profile) silver gold
8713
8714cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8715 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8716 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8717 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8718
8719cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8720 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8721 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8722 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8723 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8724 server.
8725
8726cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8727 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8728 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8729 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8730 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8731 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8732
8733cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8734 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8735 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8736 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8737 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8738
8739cook_end(<name>) <string>
8740 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8741 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8742 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8743
8744cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8745 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8746 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8747 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8748 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8749 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8750
8751cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8752 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8753 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8754 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8755 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8756 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8757
8758cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8759 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8760 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8761 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8762
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008763cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8764 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8765 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8766 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8767 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8768 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8769
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008771hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008772 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8773 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8774 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8775 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008776 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8777 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8778 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8779 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8780 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008781
8782 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008783 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008784 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8785
8786 hdr(Connection) -i close
8787
8788hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008789hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008790 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8791 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8792 response headers sent by the server.
8793
8794hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008795hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008796 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8797 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8798 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8799 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8800 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8801 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8802 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8803
8804hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008805hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008806 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8807 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8808 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8809 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8810 headers sent by the server.
8811
8812hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008813hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008814 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8815 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8816 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8817 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8818 server.
8819
8820hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008821hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8823 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8824 response headers sent by the server.
8825
8826hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008827hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8828 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8829 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8830 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008831 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8832
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008833hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008834hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008835 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8836 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8837 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8838 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8839
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008840hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008841hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008842 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008843 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8844 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8845 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8846 response headers sent by the server.
8847
8848hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008849hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008850 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8851 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8852 response headers sent by the server.
8853
8854hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008855hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008856 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8857 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8858 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8859 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8860
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008861http_auth(<userlist>)
8862http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008863 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8864 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8865 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8866 of specified groups.
8867
8868 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8869
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008870http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008871 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8872 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8873 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8874 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8875
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008876method <string>
8877 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8878 already check for most common methods.
8879
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008880path <string>
8881 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8882 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8883 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8884
8885path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008886 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8887 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008888
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008889path_dir <string>
8890 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8891 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8892 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8893 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8894
8895path_dom <string>
8896 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8897 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8898 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8899
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008900path_end <string>
8901 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8902 control file name extension.
8903
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008904path_len <integer>
8905 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8906 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008908path_reg <regex>
8909 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8910 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8911 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8912
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008913path_sub <string>
8914 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8915 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8916 "path_dir".
8917
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008918payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8919 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8920 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8921 strings.
8922
8923payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8924 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8925 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8926 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8927 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8928 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8929
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008930req_ver <string>
8931 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8932 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8933
8934status <integer>
8935 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8936 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8937 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008939url <string>
8940 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008941 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008942
8943url_beg <string>
8944 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008945 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8946 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008948url_dir <string>
8949 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8950 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8951 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8952 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8953
8954url_dom <string>
8955 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8956 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8957 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8958
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008959url_end <string>
8960 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8961 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008962
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008963url_ip <address>
8964 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8965 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8966 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008967
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008968url_len <integer>
8969 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8970 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8971
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008972url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008973 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8974 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008975 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008976 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008977
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008978url_reg <regex>
8979 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8980 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008981 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008983url_sub <string>
8984 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8985 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008986
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008987urlp(<name>) <string>
8988 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8989 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8990
8991 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8992 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8993
8994urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8995 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8996 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8997 protocol scheme.
8998
8999urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9000 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9001 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9002 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9003 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9004
9005urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9006 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9007 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9008 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9009 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9010
9011urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9012 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9013
9014urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009015 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9016 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009017
9018urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9019 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9020 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9021
9022urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9023 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9024 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9025 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9026 "urlp_" criteria.
9027
9028urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9029 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9030 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9031 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9032
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009033urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9034 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9035 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9036 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9037 negative data.
9038
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090407.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9041---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009043Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9044every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009045order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009047ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9048---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009049FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009050HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009051HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9052HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009053HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9054HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9055HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9056HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9057LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009058METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9059METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9060METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9061METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9062METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9063METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009064RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009065REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009066TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009067WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9068---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009069
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090717.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9072----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009074Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9075combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009077 - AND (implicit)
9078 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9079 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009080
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009081A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009083 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009085Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9086indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9089"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9090requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9091is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009093 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9094 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9095 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9096 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009098To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9099and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009101 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9102 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9103 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9104 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9107 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9108 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9109 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009110
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009111It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9112expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9113be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009114the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009115
9116 The following rule :
9117
9118 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9119 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9120
9121 Can also be written that way :
9122
9123 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9124
9125It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9126to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9127simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9128sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9129good use is the following :
9130
9131 With named ACLs :
9132
9133 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9134 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9135 monitor fail if site_dead
9136
9137 With anonymous ACLs :
9138
9139 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009141See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009142
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009143
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010091447.8. Pattern extraction
9145-----------------------
9146
9147The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9148response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9149for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9150
9151All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9152"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9153begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9154arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9155much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9156equivalent used in ACLs.
9157
9158The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9159
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009160 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9161 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9162 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9163 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9164 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9165 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9166 requested objects by host/path.
9167
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009168 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009169 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9170 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9171 according to RFC 4291.
9172
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009173 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9174 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9175 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009176 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9177 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9178 according to RFC 4291.
9179
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009180 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9181 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9182 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9183 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9184 type integer and only works with such tables.
9185
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009186 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9187 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9188 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9189 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9190 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9191 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9192 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009193 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009194
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009195 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9196 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9197 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9198 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9199 wiser to use "url" instead.
9200
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009201 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009202 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9203 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9204 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9205 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009206
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009207 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009208 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9209 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9210 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9211 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9212 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9213 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9214 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9215 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009216
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009217 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9218 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9219 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9220 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9221
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009222 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9223 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9224
9225 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9226 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9227 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9228
9229 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9230 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9231
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009232 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9233 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9234 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9235 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9236 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9237 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9238 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9239 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9240 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9241 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9242 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9243
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009244 ssl_c_key_alg
9245 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9246 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9247 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9248
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009249 ssl_c_notafter
9250 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9251 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9252 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9253
9254 ssl_c_notbefore
9255 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9256 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9257 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9258
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009259 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9260 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9261 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9262 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9263 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9264 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9265 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9266 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9267 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9268 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9269 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9270
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009271 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9272 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9273 layer.
9274
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009275 ssl_c_sig_alg
9276 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9277 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9278 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9279
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009280 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9281 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9282 error is encountered.
9283
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009284 ssl_c_version
9285 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9286 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9287 layer.
9288
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009289 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9290 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9291 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9292 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9293 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9294 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9295 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9296 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9297 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9298 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9299 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9300
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009301 ssl_f_key_alg
9302 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9303 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9304 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9305
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009306 ssl_f_notafter
9307 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9308 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9309 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9310
9311 ssl_f_notbefore
9312 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9313 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9314 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9315
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009316 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9317 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9318 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9319 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9320 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9321 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9322 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9323 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9324 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9325 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9326 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9327
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009328 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9329 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9330 layer.
9331
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009332 ssl_f_sig_alg
9333 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9334 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9335 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9336
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009337 ssl_f_version
9338 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9339 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9340 layer.
9341
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009342 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9343 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9344 otherwise zero.
9345
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009346 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9347 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9348 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9349
9350 ssl_fc_cipher
9351 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9352 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9353
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009354 ssl_fc_has_crt
9355 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9356 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9357
9358 ssl_fc_has_sni
9359 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009360 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9361 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009362 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009363 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009364
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009365 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009366 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9367 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9368 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9369 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009370 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009371
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009372 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009373 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9374 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009375
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009376 ssl_fc_session_id
9377 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9378 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9379 stick on a given client.
9380
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009381 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009382 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9383 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9384 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9385 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9386 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009387
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009388 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9389 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9390 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9391
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009392 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9393 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9394 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9395 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9396
9397 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9398 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9399 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9400 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9401 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9402 table for a given source address.
9403
9404 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9405 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9406
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009407 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009408 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009409 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9410 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9411 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9412 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9413 where cookies cannot be used.
9414
9415 Example :
9416 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9417 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9418 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9419 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009420
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009421 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009422 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9423 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9424 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9425 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009426
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009427 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9428 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9429 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9430 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9431 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9432 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9433 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009434
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009435 Example :
9436 listen tse-farm
9437 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9438 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9439 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9440 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9441 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9442 persist rdp-cookie
9443 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9444 # This is only useful makes sense if
9445 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9446 stick-table type string size 204800
9447 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9448 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9449 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009450
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009451 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9452 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009453
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009454 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009455 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009456 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9457 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9458 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9459 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9460 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9461 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009462
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009463 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009464
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009465 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009466 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9467 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9468 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9469
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009470 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9471 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9472 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9473 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9474 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009475
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009476 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009477
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009478
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009479The currently available list of transformations include :
9480
9481 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9482 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9483 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9484
9485 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9486 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9487 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9488
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009489 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009490 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9491 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9492 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9493 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9494
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094968. Logging
9497----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009498
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009499One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9500provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9501very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9502provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9503state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009504to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009505headers.
9506
9507In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9508about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9509send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9510
9511 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9512 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9513 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9514 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9515 at the termination.
9516
9517The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9518allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9519as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9520while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9521real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9522delay.
9523
9524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095258.1. Log levels
9526---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009527
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009528TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009529source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009530HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9531in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9532track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9533syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9534about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009535
9536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095378.2. Log formats
9538----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009539
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009540HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009541and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9542slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9543options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009544
9545 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9546 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9547 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9548 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9549 extents.
9550
9551 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9552 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9553 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9554 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9555 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9556
9557 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9558 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9559 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9560 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9561 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9562
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009563 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9564 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9565 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9566 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9567
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009568 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9569
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009570Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9571specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9572field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9573servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9574always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9575identifier.
9576
9577Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9578 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9579 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9580 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9581 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9582
9583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095848.2.1. Default log format
9585-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009586
9587This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9588as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9589format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9590
9591 Example :
9592 listen www
9593 mode http
9594 log global
9595 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9596
9597 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9598 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9599 (www/HTTP)
9600
9601 Field Format Extract from the example above
9602 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9603 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9604 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9605 4 'to' to
9606 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9607 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9608
9609Detailed fields description :
9610 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9611 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9612 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9613 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9614 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9615 and processed the connection.
9616 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9617
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009618In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9619"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9620connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009622It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9623will eventually disappear.
9624
9625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096268.2.2. TCP log format
9627---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009628
9629The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9630is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9631information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9632counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9633emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9634environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9635the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9636sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009637specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9638not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9639fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9640marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009641
9642 Example :
9643 frontend fnt
9644 mode tcp
9645 option tcplog
9646 log global
9647 default_backend bck
9648
9649 backend bck
9650 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9651
9652 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9653 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9654 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9655
9656 Field Format Extract from the example above
9657 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9658 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9659 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9660 4 frontend_name fnt
9661 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9662 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9663 7 bytes_read* 212
9664 8 termination_state --
9665 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9666 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9667
9668Detailed fields description :
9669 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009670 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9671 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9672 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9673 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9674 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009675
9676 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009677 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9678 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9679 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009680
9681 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9682 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9683 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9684 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9685
9686 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9687 and processed the connection.
9688
9689 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9690 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9691 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9692 applications.
9693
9694 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9695 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9696 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9697 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9698 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9699
9700 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9701 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9702 See "Timers" below for more details.
9703
9704 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9705 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9706 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9707 "Timers" below for more details.
9708
9709 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9710 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9711 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9712 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9713 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9714 details.
9715
9716 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9717 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9718 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9719 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9720 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9721
9722 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9723 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9724 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9725 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9726 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9727 for more details.
9728
9729 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009730 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009731 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9732 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9733 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009734 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009735
9736 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9737 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9738 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9739 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9740 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9741 caused by a denial of service attack.
9742
9743 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9744 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9745 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9746 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9747 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9748 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9749 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9750 denial of service attack.
9751
9752 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9753 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9754 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9755 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9756 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9757 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9758 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9759 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9760 be processed than on other servers.
9761
9762 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9763 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9764 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9765 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9766 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9767 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9768 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9769 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9770 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9771 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9772 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9773 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9774 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9775
9776 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9777 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9778 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9779 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9780 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9781 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9782 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9783 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9784
9785 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9786 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9787 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9788 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9789 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9790 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9791 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9792 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9793 occurs.
9794
9795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097968.2.3. HTTP log format
9797----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009798
9799The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9800is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9801the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9802are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9803emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9804generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9805"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9806which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009807frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9808is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009809
9810Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9811slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9812with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9813
9814 Example :
9815 frontend http-in
9816 mode http
9817 option httplog
9818 log global
9819 default_backend bck
9820
9821 backend static
9822 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9823
9824 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9825 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9826 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009827 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009828
9829 Field Format Extract from the example above
9830 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9831 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9832 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9833 4 frontend_name http-in
9834 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9835 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9836 7 status_code 200
9837 8 bytes_read* 2750
9838 9 captured_request_cookie -
9839 10 captured_response_cookie -
9840 11 termination_state ----
9841 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9842 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9843 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9844 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9845 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009847
9848Detailed fields description :
9849 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009850 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9851 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9852 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9853 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9854 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009855
9856 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009857 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9858 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9859 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009860
9861 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9862 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9863 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9864 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9865 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9866
9867 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9868 and processed the connection.
9869
9870 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9871 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9872 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9873
9874 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9875 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9876 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9877 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9878 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9879 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9880
9881 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9882 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9883 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9884 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9885 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9886 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9887
9888 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9889 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9890 See "Timers" below for more details.
9891
9892 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9893 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9894 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9895 below for more details.
9896
9897 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9898 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9899 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9900 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9901 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9902 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9903 for more details.
9904
9905 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9906 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9907 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9908 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9909 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9910 details.
9911
9912 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9913 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9914 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9915
9916 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9917 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9918 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9919 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9920 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9921 overflowing.
9922
9923 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9924 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9925 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9926 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9927 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9928 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9929 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9930 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9931
9932 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9933 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9934 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9935 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9936 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9937 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9938 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9939 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9940
9941 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9942 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9943 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9944 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9945 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9946 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9947 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9948
9949 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009950 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009951 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9952 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9953 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009954 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009955 system.
9956
9957 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9958 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9959 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9960 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9961 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9962 caused by a denial of service attack.
9963
9964 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9965 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9966 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9967 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9968 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9969 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9970 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9971 denial of service attack.
9972
9973 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9974 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9975 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9976 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9977 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9978 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9979 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9980 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9981 processed than on other servers.
9982
9983 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9984 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9985 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9986 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9987 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9988 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9989 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9990 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9991 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9992 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9993 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9994 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9995 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9996
9997 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9998 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9999 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10000 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10001 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10002 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10003 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10004 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10005
10006 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10007 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10008 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10009 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10010 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10011 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10012 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10013 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10014 occurs.
10015
10016 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10017 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10018 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10019 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10020 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10021 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10022 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10023 cookies" below for more details.
10024
10025 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10026 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10027 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10028 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10029 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10030 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10031 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10032 and cookies" below for more details.
10033
10034 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10035 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10036 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10037 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10038 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10039 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10040 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10041 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10042
10043
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200100448.2.4. Custom log format
10045------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010046
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010047The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10048mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010049
10050HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10051Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10052separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10053prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10054
10055Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10056variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10057string formats ("Q").
10058
10059Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10060HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10061
10062Flags are :
10063 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010064 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010065
10066 Example:
10067
10068 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10069 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10070
10071At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10072
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010073 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010074 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010075
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010076the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010077
10078 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010079 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010080 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10081
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010082and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10083
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010084 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010085 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10086
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010087Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10088
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010089 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010090 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010091 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10092 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10093 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10094 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010095 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010096 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010097 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010098 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010099 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10100 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10101 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010102 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010103 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10104 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10105 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010106 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010107 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010108 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10109 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010110 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010111 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10112 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10113 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10114 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10115 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10116 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010117 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10118 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10119 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010120 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010121 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010122 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010123 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10124 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10125 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10126 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010127 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010128 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010129 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010130 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10131 | | %s | server_name | string |
10132 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10133 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010134 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10135 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10136 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010137 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010138 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010139 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010140 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010141
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010142 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101448.3. Advanced logging options
10145-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010146
10147Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10148just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10149options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10150for more information about their usage.
10151
10152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10154------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010155
10156It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10157haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10158commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10159monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10160ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10161
10162 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10163 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10164 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10165 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10166
10167 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10168 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10169 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10170 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10171 such as other load-balancers.
10172
10173 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10174 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10175 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10176
10177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10179----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010180
10181The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10182what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10183or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10184"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10185just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10186log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10187after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10188is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10189with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10190with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10191
10192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10194------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010195
10196Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10197for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10198"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10199retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10200raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10201a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10202file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10203you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10204"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10205
10206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10208--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010209
10210Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10211multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10212them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10213"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10214logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10215error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10216and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10217too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10218useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10219alternative.
10220
10221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102228.4. Timing events
10223------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010224
10225Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10226reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10227the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10228frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10229mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10230
10231 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10232 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10233 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10234 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10235 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10236
10237 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10238 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10239 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10240 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10241 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10242
10243 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10244 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10245 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10246 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10247 connection never established.
10248
10249 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10250 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10251 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10252 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10253 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10254 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10255 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10256 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10257 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10258 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10259 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10260
10261 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10262 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10263 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10264 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10265 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10266
10267 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10268
10269 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10270 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10271 negative.
10272
10273These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10274protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10275that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010276due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010277close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10278session has been aborted on timeout.
10279
10280Most common cases :
10281
10282 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10283 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10284 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10285 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10286 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10287 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10288 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10289 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10290 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010291 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10292 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10293 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010294
10295 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10296 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10297 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10298 of ms on remote networks.
10299
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010300 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10301 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10302 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010303
10304 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10305 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10306 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10307 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10308 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10309 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10310 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10311 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10312 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10313 to the server until another one is released.
10314
10315Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10316
10317 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10318 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10319 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10320
10321 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10322 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10323 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10324
10325 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10326 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10327 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10328 flags.
10329
10330 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10331 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10332 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10333 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10334 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10335 the client connection was maintained open.
10336
10337 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10338 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10339 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10340 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10341
10342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103438.5. Session state at disconnection
10344-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010345
10346TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10347"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103482-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10349each of which has a special meaning :
10350
10351 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10352 session to terminate :
10353
10354 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10355
10356 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10357 server explicitly refused it.
10358
10359 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10360 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10361 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10362 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10363 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10364 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10365
10366 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10367 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10368 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10369 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10370 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10371
10372 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10373 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10374 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10375 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10376 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10377
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010378 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10379 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10380
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010381 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10382 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10383 backup connections when going up.
10384
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010385 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10386
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010387 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10388 send or receive data.
10389
10390 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10391 send or receive data.
10392
10393 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10394 with nothing left in the buffers.
10395
10396 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10397
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010398 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010399 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10400
10401 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10402 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10403 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10404 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10405 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10406
10407 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10408 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10409
10410 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10411 server (HTTP only).
10412
10413 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10414
10415 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10416 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10417 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10418
10419 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10420 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10421 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10422
10423 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10424
10425 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10426 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10427
10428 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10429 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10430 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10431
10432 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10433 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010434 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10435 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010436
10437 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10438 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10439 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10440 another server.
10441
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010442 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010443 server.
10444
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010445 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10446 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10447 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10448 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10449
10450 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10451 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10452 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10453 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10454
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010455 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10456 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10457 "use-server" rule).
10458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010459 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10460
10461 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10462 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10463
10464 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10465
10466 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10467 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10468 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10469
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010470 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10471 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10472 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10473 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10474 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10475
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010476 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10477
10478 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10479 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10480
10481 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10482
10483 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10484
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010485The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10486was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010487helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10488starvation, attacks, etc...
10489
10490The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10491alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10492easier finding and understanding.
10493
10494 Flags Reason
10495
10496 -- Normal termination.
10497
10498 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10499 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10500 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10501 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10502
10503 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10504 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10505 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10506 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10507 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10508 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010510 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10511 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010512 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010513
10514 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10515 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10516 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10517
10518 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10519 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10520 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10521 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10522 the server takes too long to respond.
10523
10524 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10525 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10526 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10527 long a time to respond.
10528
10529 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10530 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10531 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10532 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10533 and the client.
10534
10535 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10536 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10537 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10538 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10539 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10540 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10541
10542 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10543 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010544 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10545 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10546 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10547 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010549 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010550 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10551 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10552 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10553 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10554 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10555
10556 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10557 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10558 503 or 504 here.
10559
10560 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10561 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10562 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10563 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10564 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10565
10566 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10567 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010568 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010569 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10570 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10571
10572 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10573 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10574 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10575 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10576 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10577 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10578 between haproxy and the server.
10579
10580 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10581 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10582 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10583 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10584 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10585 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10586 solution is to fix the application.
10587
10588 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10589 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10590 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10591 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10592 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10593 external attacks.
10594
10595 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10596 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010597 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010598 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10599 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10600
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010601 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10602 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10603 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10604 the client.
10605
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010606 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10607 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10608 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10609 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010610 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10611 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10612 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10613 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10614 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010615
10616 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10617 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10618 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10619 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10620
10621 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10622 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10623 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10624 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10625
10626 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10627 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10628 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10629 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10630
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010631The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10632persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10633important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10634re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10635
10636 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10637
10638 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10639 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10640 set on a GET request.
10641
10642 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10643 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010644 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010645 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10646
10647 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10648 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10649 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10650
10651 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10652 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10653 already got a cookie.
10654
10655 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10656 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10657 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10658 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10659 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10660
10661 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10662 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10663 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10664
10665 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10666 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10667 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10668
10669 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10670 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10671
10672 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10673 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10674 then advertised in the response.
10675
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106778.6. Non-printable characters
10678-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010679
10680In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10681consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10682converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10683prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10684being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10685escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10686is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10687'}' when logging headers.
10688
10689Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10690issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10691containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10692
10693Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10694the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10695performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10696
10697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106988.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10699---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010700
10701Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10702achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010703section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010704cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10705the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10706the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010707locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010708not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10709user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10710a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10711wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10712
10713 Examples :
10714 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10715 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10716
10717 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10718 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10719
10720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107218.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10722---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010723
10724Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10725proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10726the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10727server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10728
10729Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10730response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010731section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010732
10733It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010734time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10735appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010736are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10737and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10738follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10739request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10740in the logs.
10741
10742 Example :
10743 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10744 listen proxy-out
10745 mode http
10746 option httplog
10747 option logasap
10748 log global
10749 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10750
10751 # log the name of the virtual server
10752 capture request header Host len 20
10753
10754 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10755 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10756
10757 # log the beginning of the referrer
10758 capture request header Referer len 20
10759
10760 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10761 capture response header Server len 20
10762
10763 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10764 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10765
10766 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10767 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10768
10769 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10770 capture response header Via len 20
10771
10772 # log the URL location during a redirection
10773 capture response header Location len 20
10774
10775 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10776 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10777 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10778 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10779 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10780
10781 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10782 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10783 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10784 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010785 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010786
10787 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10788 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10789 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10790 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10791 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010792 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010793
10794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107958.9. Examples of logs
10796---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010797
10798These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10799them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10800reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10801
10802 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10803 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10804 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10805
10806 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10807 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10808
10809 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10810 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10811 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10812
10813 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10814 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10815
10816 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10817 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10818 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10819
10820 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010821 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010822 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10823 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10824
10825 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10826 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10827 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10828
10829 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10830 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010831 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010832 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10833 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10834 to return the 502 and not the server.
10835
10836 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010837 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010838
10839 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10840 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10841 Nothing was sent to any server.
10842
10843 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10844 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10845
10846 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10847 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10848 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10849 send a 408 return code to the client.
10850
10851 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10852 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10853
10854 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10855 5 seconds ("c----").
10856
10857 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10858 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010859 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010860
10861 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010862 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010863 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10864 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10865 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10866 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10867 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010868
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108709. Statistics and monitoring
10871----------------------------
10872
10873It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10874mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10875CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10876Unix socket.
10877
10878
108799.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010880---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010881
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010882The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10883page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010885 0. pxname: proxy name
10886 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10887 for server)
10888 2. qcur: current queued requests
10889 3. qmax: max queued requests
10890 4. scur: current sessions
10891 5. smax: max sessions
10892 6. slim: sessions limit
10893 7. stot: total sessions
10894 8. bin: bytes in
10895 9. bout: bytes out
10896 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010897 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010898 12. ereq: request errors
10899 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010900 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010901 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10902 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010903 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010904 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10905 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10906 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10907 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10908 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10909 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10910 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10911 25. qlimit: queue limit
10912 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10913 27. iid: unique proxy id
10914 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10915 29. throttle: warm up status
10916 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10917 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010918 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010919 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10920 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10921 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010922 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010923 UNK -> unknown
10924 INI -> initializing
10925 SOCKERR -> socket error
10926 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10927 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10928 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10929 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10930 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10931 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10932 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10933 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10934 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10935 disable-on-404
10936 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10937 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10938 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010939 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10940 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010941 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10942 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10943 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10944 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10945 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10946 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010947 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10948 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10949 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10950 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010951 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10952 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010953
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109559.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010956-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010957
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010958The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010959must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10960is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10961a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10962risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10963followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10964given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10965then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10966to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010967
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010968It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10969on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10970own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010971
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010972clear counters
10973 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10974 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10975 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10976 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10977 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10978
10979clear counters all
10980 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10981 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10982 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10983
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010984clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10985 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10986
10987 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10988 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10989 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10990 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10991 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10992 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10993
10994 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10995
10996 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10997 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10998 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10999 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11000 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11001 the ACLs :
11002
11003 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11004 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11005 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11006 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11007 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11008 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11009
11010 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011011 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11012 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011013
11014 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011015 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011016 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011017 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11018 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11019 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11020 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011021
11022 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11023
11024 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011025 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011026 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11027 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011028 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11029 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11030 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011031
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011032disable frontend <frontend>
11033 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11034 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11035 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11036 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11037 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11038 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11039 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11040 on the stats page.
11041
11042 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11043 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11044
11045 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11046 level "admin".
11047
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011048disable server <backend>/<server>
11049 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11050 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11051 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11052 during the maintenance.
11053
11054 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11055 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11056
11057 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011058 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011059
11060 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11061 level "admin".
11062
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011063enable frontend <frontend>
11064 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11065 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11066 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11067 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11068 which was disabled.
11069
11070 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11071 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11072
11073 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11074 level "admin".
11075
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011076enable server <backend>/<server>
11077 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11078 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11079
11080 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011081 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011082
11083 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11084 level "admin".
11085
11086get weight <backend>/<server>
11087 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11088 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11089 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11090 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11091 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011092 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011093
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011094help
11095 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11096 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011097
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011098prompt
11099 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11100 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11101 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11102 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11103 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11104 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11105 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11106 command.
11107
11108quit
11109 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011110
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011111set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011112 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11113 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11114 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11115 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11116 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011117 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11118 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11119
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011120set maxconn global <maxconn>
11121 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11122 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11123 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11124 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11125 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11126 setting.
11127
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011128set rate-limit connections global <value>
11129 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11130 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11131 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11132 is passed in number of connections per second.
11133
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011134set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11135 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11136 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
11137 passed in number of kilobytes per second.
11138
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011139set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11140 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11141 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11142 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11143 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11144 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11145
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011146set timeout cli <delay>
11147 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11148 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11149 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11150
11151set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11152 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11153 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11154 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11155 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11156 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11157 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11158 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11159 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11160 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11161 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11162 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11163 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11164 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011165 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011166
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011167show errors [<iid>]
11168 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11169 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011170 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11171 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11172 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011173
11174 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11175 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11176 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11177 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11178 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11179 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11180 are reported too.
11181
11182 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11183 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11184 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11185 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11186 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11187 code.
11188
11189 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11190 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11191 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11192 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11193 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11194 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11195 line.
11196
11197 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011198 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11199 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011200 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11201 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11202
11203 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11204 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11205 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11206 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11207 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11208 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11209 00204+ minal\r\n
11210 00211 \r\n
11211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011212 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011213 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11214 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11215 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11216 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11217 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11218 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011219
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011220show info
11221 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11222
11223show sess
11224 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011225 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11226 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11227
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011228show sess <id>
11229 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11230 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11231 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11232 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11233 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11234 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011235
11236show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11237 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11238 possible to dump only selected items :
11239 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11240 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11241 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11242 for example:
11243 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11244 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11245 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11246
11247 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011248 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11249 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011250 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11251 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11252 Nbproc: 1
11253 Process_num: 1
11254 (...)
11255
11256 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11257 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11258 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11259 (...)
11260 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11261
11262 $
11263
11264 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11265 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11266 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11267 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011268 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011269
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011270show table
11271 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11272 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11273 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11274 entries currently in use.
11275
11276 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011277 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011278 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11279 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011280
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011281show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011282 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11283 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11284 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011285 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11286
11287 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11288 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11289 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11290 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11291 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11292
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011293 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11294 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11295 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11296 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11297 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11298 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11299
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011300
11301 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011302 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11303 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011304
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011305 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011306 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011307 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011308 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11309 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11310 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11311 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011312
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011313 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011314 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011315 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11316 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011317
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011318 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11319 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011320 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011321 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11322 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011323
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011324 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11325 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011326 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011327 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11328 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11329
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011330 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11331 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11332 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11333 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11334 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11335
11336 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11337 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11338 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011339 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11340 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011341 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11342 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011343
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011344shutdown frontend <frontend>
11345 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11346 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11347 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11348 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11349 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11350 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11351 once it is terminated.
11352
11353 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11354 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11355
11356 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11357 level "admin".
11358
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011359shutdown session <id>
11360 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11361 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11362 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11363 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11364 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11365 flag in the logs.
11366
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011367shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11368 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11369 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11370 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11371 'K' flag in the logs.
11372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011373/*
11374 * Local variables:
11375 * fill-column: 79
11376 * End:
11377 */